blob: de7384bfc9a3c7d12e75b1d38ee6272b2cb26a7b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau4462af82020-06-26 22:01:04 +02007 2020/06/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200606 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100609 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100611 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200612 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200614 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200617 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - presetenv
619 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 - uid
621 - ulimit-n
622 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200623 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100624 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200625 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200628 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-bind-options
630 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200631 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - ssl-default-server-options
633 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100634 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200635 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100636 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100637 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100638 - 51degrees-data-file
639 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200640 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200641 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-data-file
643 - wurfl-information-list
644 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200645 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100646 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100649 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200650 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200652 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100653 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100654 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100655 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200656 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200657 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200658 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200659 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - noepoll
661 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000662 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200663 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300665 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000666 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100667 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200668 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200669 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200670 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000671 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000672 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200673 - tune.buffers.limit
674 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200675 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200676 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100677 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200678 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200679 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200680 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200681 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100682 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200683 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200684 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100685 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100687 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100688 - tune.lua.session-timeout
689 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200690 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100691 - tune.maxaccept
692 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200693 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200694 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200695 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200696 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
697 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.rcvbuf.client
699 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100700 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200701 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200702 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100703 - tune.sndbuf.client
704 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100705 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100706 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200707 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100708 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200709 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200710 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100711 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200712 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100713 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200714 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
715 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
716 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100717 - tune.zlib.memlevel
718 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720 * Debugging
721 - debug
722 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200723 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724
725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007263.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200727------------------------------------
728
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200729ca-base <dir>
730 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100731 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
732 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
733 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200734
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200735chroot <jail dir>
736 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
737 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
738 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
739 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
740 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100741 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100742
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100743cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
744 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
745 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
746 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
747 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
748 set. These sets have the format
749
750 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
751
752 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100753 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
755 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100756 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
757 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100758 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100759 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100761 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100762 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
763 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
764 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
765 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100766
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100767 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
768 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
769 on the machine's word size.
770
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100772 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
773 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
774 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
775 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
776 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
777 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100778
779 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100780 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
781
782 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
783 # first 4 CPUs
784
785 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
786 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
787 # word size.
788
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100790 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100791 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
792 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
793 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
794
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100795 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
796 # and so on.
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
798 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
799 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
800
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100801 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100802 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
803 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
804 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
805
806 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
807 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
809
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100810 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
811 # and a thread range.
812 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
813 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
814 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
815
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816crt-base <dir>
817 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100818 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
819 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200820
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200821daemon
822 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
823 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100824 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
825 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200826
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827deviceatlas-json-file <path>
828 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200830
831deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100832 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200833 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
834
835deviceatlas-separator <char>
836 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
837 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
838
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100839deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200840 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
841 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
842 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100843
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900844external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100845 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
846 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100847 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
848 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
849 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
850 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
851 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900852
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853gid <number>
854 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
855 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
856 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100857 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
858 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200859 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100860
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100861group <group name>
862 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
863 See also "gid" and "user".
864
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100865hard-stop-after <time>
866 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
867
868 Arguments :
869 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
870 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
871 SIGUSR1 signal.
872
873 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
874 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
875 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
876
877 Example:
878 global
879 hard-stop-after 30s
880
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200881h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
882 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
883 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
884 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
885 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500886 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200887 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
888 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
889 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
890 specified in a proxy.
891
892 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
893 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
894 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
895 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
896 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
897 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
898 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
899
900 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
901 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
902 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
903 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
904 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
905
906 Example:
907 global
908 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
909
910 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
911 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
912
913h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
914 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
915 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
916 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
917 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
918 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
919 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
920 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
921 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
922
923 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
924 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
925 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
926
927 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
928 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
929
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100930insecure-fork-wanted
931 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
932 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
933 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
934 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
935 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
936 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
937 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
938 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
939 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
940 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
941 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
942 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
943 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
944 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
945 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
946 disable it.
947
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100948insecure-setuid-wanted
949 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
950 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
951 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
952 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
953 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
954 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
955 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
956 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
957 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
958 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
959 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
960 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
961 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
962 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
963
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100964issuers-chain-path <dir>
965 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
966 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
967 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
968 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
969 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
970 "issuers-chain-path".
971 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
972 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
973 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
974 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
975 will share the chain in memory.
976
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200977localpeer <name>
978 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
979 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
980 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
981 the configuration parsing.
982
983 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
984 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
985
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200986log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
987 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100988 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100990 configured with "log global".
991
992 <address> can be one of:
993
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100994 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100995 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
996 port).
997
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100998 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
999 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1000 port).
1001
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001002 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001003 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1004 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001005 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001006
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001007 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1008 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1009 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1010 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1011 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1012 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1013 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1014 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1015 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1016 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1017 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1018 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1019 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1020 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001021 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1022 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001023
1024 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1025 "fd@2", see above.
1026
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001027 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1028 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1029 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1030 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1031 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1032
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001033 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1034 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001035
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001036 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1037 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1038 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1039 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1040 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1041 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1042 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1043 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1044 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1045 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001046 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1047 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001048
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001049 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1050 one of the following :
1051
1052 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1053 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1054
1055 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1056 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1057
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001058 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1059 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1060 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1061 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1062 logger consumes.
1063
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001064 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1065 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1066 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1067 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1068
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001069 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1070 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1071 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1072 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1073 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1074
1075 <sample_size>
1076 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1077 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1078 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1079 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1080 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1081
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001082 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001084 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1085 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1086 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1087
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001088 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1089 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1090 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1091 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001092
1093 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001094 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1095 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1096 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1097 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1098 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1099 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001100
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001101 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001103log-send-hostname [<string>]
1104 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1105 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1106 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1107 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1108 the logs.
1109
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001110log-tag <string>
1111 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1112 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1113 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001114 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001115
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001116lua-load <file>
1117 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1118 used multiple times.
1119
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001120lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1121 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1122 variable.
1123 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1124 to "path".
1125
1126 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1127 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1128 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1129 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1130 will be checked earlier.
1131
1132 As an example by specifying the following path:
1133
1134 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1135 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1136
1137 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1138 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1139 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1140 paths if that does not exist either.
1141
1142 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1143 documentation.
1144
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001145master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001146 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1147 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1148 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001149 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001150 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1151 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001152 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1153 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1154 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1155 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1156 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001157
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001158 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001159
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001160mworker-max-reloads <number>
1161 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001162 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001163 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1164 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1165 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1166
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001167nbproc <number>
1168 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1169 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1170 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001171 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1172 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001173 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1174 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001176nbthread <number>
1177 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001178 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1179 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1180 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1181 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1182 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001183 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1184 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1185 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1186 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1187 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1188 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1189 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001190
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001191pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001192 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001193 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1194 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1195
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001196pp2-never-send-local
1197 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1198 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1199 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1200 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1201 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1202 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1203 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1204 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1205 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1206 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1207 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1208
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001209presetenv <name> <value>
1210 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1211 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1212 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1213 and "unsetenv".
1214
1215resetenv [<name> ...]
1216 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1217 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1218 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1219 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1220 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1221 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1222 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1223 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1224
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001225stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001226 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1227 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1228 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1229 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1230 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1231 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001232 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001233 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1234 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1235 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1236 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001237
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001238server-state-base <directory>
1239 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001240 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1241 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001242
1243server-state-file <file>
1244 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1245 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1246 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1247 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1248 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1249 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1250 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1251 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001252 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1253 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001254
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001255setenv <name> <value>
1256 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1257 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1258 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1259 and "unsetenv".
1260
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001261set-dumpable
1262 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001263 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1264 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1265 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1266 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1267 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1268 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1269 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1270 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1271 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1272 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1273 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1274 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1275 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1276 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1277 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1278 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1279 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001280
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001281ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1283 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001284 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001285 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001286 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1287 information and recommendations see e.g.
1288 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1289 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1290 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1291 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001292
1293ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1295 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1296 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1297 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1298 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001299 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1300 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1301 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001302 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001303
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001304ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1306 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1307 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1308 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1309 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1310
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001311ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1313 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1314 keyword to see available options.
1315
1316 Example:
1317 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001318 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001319
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001320ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1322 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001323 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001324 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001325 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1326 information and recommendations see e.g.
1327 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1328 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1329 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1330 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1331 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001332
1333ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1335 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1336 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1337 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1338 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001339 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1340 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1341 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1342 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001343
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001344ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1346 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1347 keyword to see available options.
1348
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001349ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1351 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1352 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001353 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001354 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001355 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1356 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1357 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1358 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001359 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1360 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1361 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1362
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001363ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001364 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1365 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1366
1367 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1368 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1369 optimize the startup time.
1370
1371 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1372 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1373 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1374
1375 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001376 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001377
1378 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1379 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1380 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1381 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1382 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1383 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001384 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001385 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1386
1387 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1388
1389 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1390
1391 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1392 not provided in the PEM file.
1393
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001394 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1395 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1396
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001397 The default behavior is "all".
1398
1399 Example:
1400 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1401 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1402 ssl-load-extra-files none
1403
1404 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1405
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001406ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1407 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1408 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1409 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1410
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001411ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1412 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1413 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1414 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1415 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1416 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1417 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1418 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1419 bits does not need it.
1420
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001421stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1422 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1423 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1424 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001425 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001426 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001427
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001428 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1429 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1430 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001431
1432stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1433 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1434 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001435 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001436
1437stats maxconn <connections>
1438 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1439 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441uid <number>
1442 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1443 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1444 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1445 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1446
1447ulimit-n <number>
1448 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1449 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1450 option.
1451
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001452unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1453 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1454
1455 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1456 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1457 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1458 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1459 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1460 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1461 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1462 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1463 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1464 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1465
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001466unsetenv [<name> ...]
1467 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1468 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1469 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1470 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1471 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1472 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1473 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1474
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475user <user name>
1476 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1477 See also "uid" and "group".
1478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001479node <name>
1480 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1481
1482 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1483 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1484 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1485 traffic.
1486
1487description <text>
1488 Add a text that describes the instance.
1489
1490 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1491 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1492 "<" and ">" characters.
1493
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100149451degrees-data-file <file path>
1495 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001496 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001497
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001498 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001499 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1500
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000150151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001502 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1503 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1504 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1505
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001506 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001507 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1508
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200150951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001510 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1511 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1512
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001513 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1514 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1515
151651degrees-cache-size <number>
1517 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1518 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1519 By default, this cache is disabled.
1520
1521 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001522 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1523
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001524wurfl-data-file <file path>
1525 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1526 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1527
1528 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1529 with USE_WURFL=1.
1530
1531wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1532 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1533 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1534 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1535
1536 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1537
1538 Valid WURFL properties are:
1539 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1540
1541 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1542 device.
1543
1544 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1545 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1546
1547 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1548 particular web request.
1549
1550 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1551 used Libwurfl API version.
1552
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001553 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1554 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1555
1556 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1557 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1558
1559 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1560
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001561 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1562 with USE_WURFL=1.
1563
1564wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1565 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1566 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1567
1568 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1569 with USE_WURFL=1.
1570
1571wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1572 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1573 thus before the chroot.
1574
1575 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1576 with USE_WURFL=1.
1577
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001578wurfl-cache-size <size>
1579 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1580 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001581 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001582 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001583
1584 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1585 with USE_WURFL=1.
1586
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001587strict-limits
1588 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1589 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1590 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1591 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1592 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1593 keyword.
1594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015953.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001596-----------------------
1597
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001598busy-polling
1599 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1600 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1601 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1602 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1603 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1604 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1605 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1606 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1607 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1608 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1609 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1610 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1611 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1612 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1613 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1614 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1615 "poll" pollers.
1616
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001617 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1618 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1619 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1620
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001621max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1622 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1623 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1624 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1625 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1626 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1627 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1628 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1629 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001631maxconn <number>
1632 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1633 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1634 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001635 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1636 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1637 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1638 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001639 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1640 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1641 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1642 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1643 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1644 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001645
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001646maxconnrate <number>
1647 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1648 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1649 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1650 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1651 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1652 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1653 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1654 fairness.
1655
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001656maxcomprate <number>
1657 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001658 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001659 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1660 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1661 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001662 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001663 default value.
1664
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001665maxcompcpuusage <number>
1666 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1667 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1668 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1669 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1670 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1671 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1672 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1673 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1674
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001675maxpipes <number>
1676 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1677 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1678 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1679 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1680 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1681 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1682
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001683maxsessrate <number>
1684 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1685 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1686 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1687 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1688 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1689 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1690 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1691 fairness.
1692
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001693maxsslconn <number>
1694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1695 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1696 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1697 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1698 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1699 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1700 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001701 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1702 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1703 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1704 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1705 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1706 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1707 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001708
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001709maxsslrate <number>
1710 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1711 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1712 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1713 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1714 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1715 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1716 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1717 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1718 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1719 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1720
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001721maxzlibmem <number>
1722 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1723 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1724 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001725 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1726 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1727 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729noepoll
1730 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1731 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001732 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001733
1734nokqueue
1735 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1736 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1737 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1738
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001739noevports
1740 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1741 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1742 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1743 also "nopoll".
1744
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001745nopoll
1746 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1747 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001749 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1750 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001751
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001752nosplice
1753 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001754 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001755 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001756 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001757 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1758 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1759 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1760 "option splice-response".
1761
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001762nogetaddrinfo
1763 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1764 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1765
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001766noreuseport
1767 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1768 command line argument "-dR".
1769
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001770profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1771 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1772 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1773 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1774 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001775 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001776 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1777 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1778 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1779 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1780
1781 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1782 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1783 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1784 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1785 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001786 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1787 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1788 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1789 CLI.
1790
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001791spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001792 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1793 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1794 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1795 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1796 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1797 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001799ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001800 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001802 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1803 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1804 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1805 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1806 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001807 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1808 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001809 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1810 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1811 openssl configuration file uses:
1812 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1813
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001814ssl-mode-async
1815 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001816 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001817 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1818 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1819 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001820 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001821 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001822
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001823tune.buffers.limit <number>
1824 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1825 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1826 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1827 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1828 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001829 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001830 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1831 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1832 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1833 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1834 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1835 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1836 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1837 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1838 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1839
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001840tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1841 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1842 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1843 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1844 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1845
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001846tune.bufsize <number>
1847 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1848 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1849 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1850 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1851 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1852 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1853 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001854 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1855 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1856 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001857 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001858 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1859 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1860 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001861
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001862tune.chksize <number>
1863 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1864 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1865 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1866 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1867 checks whenever possible.
1868
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001869tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1870 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1871 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1872 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1873 this value. The default value is 1.
1874
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001875tune.fail-alloc
1876 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1877 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1878 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1879 gracefully.
1880
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001881tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1882 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1883 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1884 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1885 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1886 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1887
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001888tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1889 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1890 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1891 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1892 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1893 change it.
1894
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001895tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1896 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001897 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1898 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001899 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1900 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1901 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1902 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1903 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1904
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001905tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1906 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1907 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1908 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1909 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1910 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1911 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1912 recommended not to change this value.
1913
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001914tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1915 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1916 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1917 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1918 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1919 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1920 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1921 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1922
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001923tune.http.cookielen <number>
1924 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1925 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1926 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1927 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1928 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1929 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1930 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1931 to change this value.
1932
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001933tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001934 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1935 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001936 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001937 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001938 configuration directives too.
1939 The default value is 1024.
1940
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001941tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1942 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1943 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1944 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1945 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1946 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1947 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001948 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1949 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1950 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001951
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001952tune.idletimer <timeout>
1953 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1954 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1955 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1956 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1957 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1958 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001959 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001960 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001961 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1962
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001963tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1964 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1965 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1966 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1967 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1968 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1969 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1970 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1971 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1972 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1973
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001974tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1975 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001976 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001977 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1978 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001979 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001980 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1981 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1982
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001983tune.lua.maxmem
1984 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1985 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1986 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1987 memory.
1988
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001989tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1990 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001991 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1992 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001993 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001994
1995tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1996 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1997 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1998 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1999 check servers.
2000
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002001tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2002 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2003 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2004 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002005 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002006
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002007tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002008 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2009 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2010 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2011 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2012 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2013 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2014 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2015 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2016 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2017 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002018
2019tune.maxpollevents <number>
2020 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2021 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2022 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2023 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2024 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2025
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002026tune.maxrewrite <number>
2027 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2028 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2029 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2030 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2031 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2032 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2033 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2034 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2035 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2036 bufsize.
2037
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002038tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2039 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2040 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2041 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2042 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2043 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2044 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2045 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2046 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2047 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002048 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2049 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002050 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2051 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2052 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2053 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2054 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2055 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2056 setting this parameter to 0.
2057
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002058tune.pipesize <number>
2059 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2060 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2061 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2062 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2063 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2064 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2065
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002066tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2067 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2068 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2069 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2070 default is 20.
2071
2072tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2073 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2074 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2075 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2076 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2077 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2078 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002079 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002080
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002081tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2082tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2083 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2084 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2085 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002086 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002087 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002088 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2089 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2090
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002091tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002092 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002093 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2094 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2095 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2096 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2097
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002098tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002099 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002100 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002101 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2102 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2103 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2104
2105tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2106 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2107 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2108 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2109 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2110 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2111 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2112 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2113 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2114 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002115
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002116tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2117tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2118 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2119 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2120 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002121 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002122 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002123 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2124 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2125 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2126 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2127 notifying haproxy again.
2128
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002129tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002130 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2131 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2132 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002133 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002134 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002135 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002136 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2137 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2138 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002139 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2140 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002141
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002142tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002143 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002144 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2145 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2146 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2147 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2148 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2149
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002150tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2151 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002152 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002153 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2154 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2155 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2156 being used for too long.
2157
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002158tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2159 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2160 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2161 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2162 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2163 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2164 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2165 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2166 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2167 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2168 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002169 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002170 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002171
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002172tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2173 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2174 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2175 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2176 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002177 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002178 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2179 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002180 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2181 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002182
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002183tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2184 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2185 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2186 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2187 1000 entries.
2188
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002189tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2190 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2191 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2192 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2193
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002194tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002195tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002196tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2197tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2198tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002199 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2200 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2201 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2202 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2203 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2204 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2205 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2206 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002207
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002208 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2209 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2210 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2211 all available space is consumed.
2212 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2213 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2214 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002215
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002216tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2217 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002218 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002219 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002220 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002221 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2222
2223tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2224 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2225 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002226 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2227 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022293.3. Debugging
2230--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002231
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002232debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002233 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2234 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2235 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2236 system startup.
2237
2238quiet
2239 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2240 line argument "-q".
2241
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002242zero-warning
2243 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2244 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2245 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2246 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2247 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2248 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2249
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022513.4. Userlists
2252--------------
2253It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2254http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2255it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2256
2257userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002258 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002259 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2260
2261group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002262 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002263 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2264 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2265
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002266user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2267 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002268 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2269 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002270 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2271 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2272 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2273 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002274
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002275 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2276 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2277 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2278 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2279 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2280 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2281 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2282 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2283 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002284
2285 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002286 userlist L1
2287 group G1 users tiger,scott
2288 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002289
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002290 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2291 user scott insecure-password elgato
2292 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002293
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002294 userlist L2
2295 group G1
2296 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002297
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002298 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2299 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2300 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002301
2302 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002304
23053.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002306----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002307It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2308several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2309instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2310values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2311automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2312In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2313using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2314tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2315reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2316Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2317that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2318each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002319
2320peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002321 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002322 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2323
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002324bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2325 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2326 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2327
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002328disabled
2329 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2330 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2331 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2332
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002333default-bind [param*]
2334 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2335
2336default-server [param*]
2337 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2338
2339 Arguments:
2340 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2341 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2342 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2343 details.
2344
2345
2346 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2347
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002348enable
2349 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2350
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002351log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2352 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2353 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2354 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2355 more details.
2356
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002357peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002358 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2359 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002360 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2361 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2362 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2363 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2364 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002365
2366 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2367 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2368
2369 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002370 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2371 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2372 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002373
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002374 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2375 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002376
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002377 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2378 "server" keyword explanation below).
2379
2380server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002381 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002382 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2383 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2384 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2385 of this "peers" section).
2386 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2387
2388
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002389 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002390 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002391 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002392 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2393 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2394 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002395
2396 backend mybackend
2397 mode tcp
2398 balance roundrobin
2399 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2400 stick on src
2401
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002402 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2403 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002404
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002405 Example:
2406 peers mypeers
2407 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2408 default-server ssl verify none
2409 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2410 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002411
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002412
2413table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2414 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2415
2416 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2417 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002418 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002419 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2420 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2421 "stick-table" keyword).
2422
2423 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2424 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2425 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2426 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2427 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2428 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2429 of the stick-table name as follows:
2430
2431 peers mypeers
2432 peer A ...
2433 peer B ...
2434 table t1 ...
2435
2436 frontend fe1
2437 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2438
2439 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2440 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2441
2442 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2443 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2444 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2445 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2446 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2447 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2448 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2449
2450 peers mypeers
2451 peer A ...
2452 peer B ...
2453 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2454
2455 backend t1
2456 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2457
2458 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2459 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2460 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2461
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024623.6. Mailers
2463------------
2464It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2465If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2466in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2467
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002468mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002469 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2470 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2471
2472mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2473 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2474
2475 Example:
2476 mailers mymailers
2477 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2478 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2479
2480 backend mybackend
2481 mode tcp
2482 balance roundrobin
2483
2484 email-alert mailers mymailers
2485 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2486 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2487
2488 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2489 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2490
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002491timeout mail <time>
2492 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2493 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2494 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2495 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2496
2497 Example:
2498 mailers mymailers
2499 timeout mail 20s
2500 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002501
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025023.7. Programs
2503-------------
2504In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2505master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2506managed the same way as the workers.
2507
2508During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2509sequence as a worker:
2510
2511 - the master is re-executed
2512 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2513 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2514 instance of the program
2515
2516During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2517
2518program <name>
2519 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2520 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2521 the management guide).
2522
2523command <command> [arguments*]
2524 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2525 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2526 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2527 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2528
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002529user <user name>
2530 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2531 See also "group".
2532
2533group <group name>
2534 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2535 See also "user".
2536
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002537option start-on-reload
2538no option start-on-reload
2539 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2540 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2541 program section.
2542
2543
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025443.8. HTTP-errors
2545----------------
2546
2547It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2548imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2549several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2550
2551http-errors <name>
2552 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2553 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2554
2555errorfile <code> <file>
2556 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2557
2558 Arguments :
2559 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002560 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2561 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002562
2563 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2564 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2565 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2566 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2567 before any chroot is performed.
2568
2569 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2570
2571 Example:
2572 http-errors website-1
2573 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2574 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2575 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2576
2577 http-errors website-2
2578 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2579 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2580 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2581
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020025823.9. Rings
2583----------
2584
2585It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2586servers or traces.
2587
2588ring <ringname>
2589 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2590
2591description <text>
2592 The descritpition is an optional description string of the ring. It will
2593 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2594
2595format <format>
2596 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2597
2598 Arguments:
2599 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2600 one of the following :
2601
2602 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2603 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2604 designed to be used with a local log server.
2605
2606 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2607 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2608 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2609 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2610 is the default.
2611
2612 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2613 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2614
2615 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2616 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2617
2618 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2619 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2620 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2621 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2622 logger consumes.
2623
2624 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2625 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2626 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2627 used with a local log server.
2628
2629maxlen <length>
2630 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2631 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2632 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2633
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002634server <name> <address> [param*]
2635 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2636 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2637 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2638 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2639 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2640 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2641 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2642 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2643 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002644 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2645 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002646
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002647size <size>
2648 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2649 set to BUFSIZE.
2650
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002651timeout connect <timeout>
2652 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2653
2654 Arguments :
2655 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2656 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2657 as explained at the top of this document.
2658
2659timeout server <timeout>
2660 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2661
2662 Arguments :
2663 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2664 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2665 as explained at the top of this document.
2666
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002667 Example:
2668 global
2669 log ring@myring local7
2670
2671 ring myring
2672 description "My local buffer"
2673 format rfc3164
2674 maxlen 1200
2675 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002676 timeout connect 5s
2677 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002678 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002679
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026814. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002682----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002684Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002685 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002686 - frontend <name>
2687 - backend <name>
2688 - listen <name>
2689
2690A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2691its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2692section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002694
2695A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2696connections.
2697
2698A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2699to forward incoming connections.
2700
2701A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2702parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002704All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2705'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2706case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2707
2708Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2709logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2710proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2711However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2712name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2713
2714Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2715and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002716bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002717protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2718modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2719arbitrary criteria.
2720
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002721In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2722a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002723the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002724
2725 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2726 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2727 between responses and new requests.
2728
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002729 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2730 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2731 client-facing connection remains open.
2732
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002733 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2734 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002735
2736The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2737frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2738following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002739weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002740
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002741 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002742
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002743 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2744 ----+-----+-----+----
2745 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2746 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002747 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2748 ----+-----+-----+----
2749 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2754--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002756The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2757limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2758they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2759limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002760marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002761option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002762and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2763with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2764specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002766
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002767 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2768------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2769acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002770backlog X X X -
2771balance X - X X
2772bind - X X -
2773bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002774capture cookie - X X -
2775capture request header - X X -
2776capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002777compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002778cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002779declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780default-server X - X X
2781default_backend X X X -
2782description - X X X
2783disabled X X X X
2784dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002785email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002786email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002787email-alert mailers X X X X
2788email-alert myhostname X X X X
2789email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002790enabled X X X X
2791errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002792errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002793errorloc X X X X
2794errorloc302 X X X X
2795-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2796errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002797force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002798filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002799fullconn X - X X
2800grace X X X X
2801hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002802http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002803http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002804http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002805http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002806http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002807http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002808http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002809http-check set-var X - X X
2810http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002811http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002812http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002813http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002814http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002815http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002816id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002817ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002818load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002819log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002820log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002821log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002822log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002823max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002824maxconn X X X -
2825mode X X X X
2826monitor fail - X X -
2827monitor-net X X X -
2828monitor-uri X X X -
2829option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2830option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2831option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2832option allbackups (*) X - X X
2833option checkcache (*) X - X X
2834option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2835option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002836option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002837option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2838option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002839-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2840option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002841option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2842option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002843option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002844option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002845option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002846option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002847option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002848option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2849option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2850option httpchk X - X X
2851option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002852option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002853option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002854option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002855option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002856option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002857option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2858option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2859option logasap (*) X X X -
2860option mysql-check X - X X
2861option nolinger (*) X X X X
2862option originalto X X X X
2863option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002864option pgsql-check X - X X
2865option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002866option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002867option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002868option smtpchk X - X X
2869option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2870option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2871option splice-request (*) X X X X
2872option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002873option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002874option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2875option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2876-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002877option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002878option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2879option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2880option tcpka X X X X
2881option tcplog X X X X
2882option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002883external-check command X - X X
2884external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002885persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2886rate-limit sessions X X X -
2887redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002888-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002889retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002890retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002891server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002892server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002893server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002894source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002895stats admin - X X X
2896stats auth X X X X
2897stats enable X X X X
2898stats hide-version X X X X
2899stats http-request - X X X
2900stats realm X X X X
2901stats refresh X X X X
2902stats scope X X X X
2903stats show-desc X X X X
2904stats show-legends X X X X
2905stats show-node X X X X
2906stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002907-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2908stick match - - X X
2909stick on - - X X
2910stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002911stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002912stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002913tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002914tcp-check connect X - X X
2915tcp-check expect X - X X
2916tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002917tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002918tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002919tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002920tcp-check set-var X - X X
2921tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002922tcp-request connection - X X -
2923tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002924tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002925tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002926tcp-response content - - X X
2927tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002928timeout check X - X X
2929timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002930timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002931timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002932timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2933timeout http-request X X X X
2934timeout queue X - X X
2935timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002936timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002937timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002938timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002939transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002940unique-id-format X X X -
2941unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002942use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002943use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002944use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002945------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2946 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029494.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2950---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
2952This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2953
2954
2955acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2956 Declare or complete an access list.
2957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2958 no | yes | yes | yes
2959 Example:
2960 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2961 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2962 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002964 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
2966
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002967backlog <conns>
2968 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2970 yes | yes | yes | no
2971 Arguments :
2972 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2973 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002974 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002975
2976 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2977 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2978 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2979 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2980 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2981 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2982 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2983 backlog parameter.
2984
2985 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2986 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2987 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2988
2989 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2990
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002993balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002994 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 yes | no | yes | yes
2997 Arguments :
2998 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2999 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3000 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3001 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3002
3003 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3004 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3005 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3006 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003007 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003008 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003009 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3010 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3011 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3012 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3013 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3014 it, so that you don't worry.
3015
3016 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3017 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3018 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3019 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3020 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3021 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3022 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3023 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003024
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003025 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3026 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3027 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3028 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3029 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3030 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3031 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3032 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3033
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003034 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003035 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003036 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3037 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003038 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003039 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3040 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3041 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3042 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3043 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003044 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3045 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3046 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3047 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3048 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3049 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003051 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3052 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3053 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3054 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3055 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3056 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3057 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3058 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003059 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003060 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003061 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3062 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3063 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003064
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003065 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3066 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3067 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3068 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3069 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3070 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3071 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3072 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3073 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3074 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3075 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3076 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003078 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003079 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3080 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3081 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3082 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3083 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3084 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3085 URIs start with a leading "/".
3086
3087 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3088 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3089 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3090 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003093 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3094
3095 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003096 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3097 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003098 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3099 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3100 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3101 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003102 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003103 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3104 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003105
3106 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3107 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3108 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3109 server will receive the request.
3110
3111 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3112 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3113 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3114 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3115 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003116 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3117 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3118 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003120 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3121 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3122 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3123 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3124 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003126 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003127 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3128 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3129 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3130
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003131 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3132 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3133 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3134
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003135 random
3136 random(<draws>)
3137 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003138 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3139 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3140 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3141 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003142 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3143 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3144 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3145 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3146 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3147 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3148 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3149 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3150 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3151 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3152 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3153 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3154 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3155 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3156 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3157 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3158 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3159 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3160 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3161 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003162
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003163 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003164 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003165 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3166 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3167 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3168 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3169 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3170 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003171 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003172 used instead.
3173
3174 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3175 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3176 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3177 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3178
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003179 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3180 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3181 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3182
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003183 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003184
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003185 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003186 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3187 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003188
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003189 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3190 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3191 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003193 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003194 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003195 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3196 NTLM relies on.
3197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003198 Examples :
3199 balance roundrobin
3200 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003201 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003202 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3203 balance hdr(host)
3204 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003205
3206 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3207 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003209 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003210 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3211 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3212 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003213 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003214
3215 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3216 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3217 defaults to 16 kB.
3218
3219 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3220 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3221
3222 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3223 Round Robin.
3224
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003225 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003226 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3227 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3228 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3229
3230 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3231
3232 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003233 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003234 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3235 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3236 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003238 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003239
3240
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003241bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3242bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003243 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3245 no | yes | yes | no
3246 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003247 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3248 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3249 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3250 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003251 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003252 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3253 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3254 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3255 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3256 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3257 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3258 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003259 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3260 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3261 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3262 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3263 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3264 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3265 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003266 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3267 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3268 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003269 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3270 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3271 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3272 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003273 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3274 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3275 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003276
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003277 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3278 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003279 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3280 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3281 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003282 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3283 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3284 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3285 the range.
3286
3287 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3288 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3289 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3290 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3291 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3292 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3293 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003294 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003295 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003297 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003298 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003299 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3300 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3301 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3302 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3303 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3304 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003306 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3307 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3308 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3309 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003310
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003311 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3312 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3313 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3314 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3315 in a frontend.
3316
3317 Example :
3318 listen http_proxy
3319 bind :80,:443
3320 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003321 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003323 listen http_https_proxy
3324 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003325 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003326
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003327 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3328 bind ipv6@:80
3329 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3330 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3331
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003332 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003333 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003334
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003335 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3336 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3337 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3338 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3339 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3340
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003341 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003342 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003343
3344
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003345bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003346 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3348 yes | yes | yes | yes
3349 Arguments :
3350 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3351 may be used to override a default value.
3352
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003353 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003354 option may be combined with other numbers.
3355
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003356 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003357 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3358 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3359 missing from all processes.
3360
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003361 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003362 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003363 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3364 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3365 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3366 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3367 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003368 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003369
3370 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3371 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3372 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3373 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3374 and 'even' instances.
3375
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003376 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3377 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3378 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3379 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003380
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003381 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3382 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3383
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003384 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3385 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3386 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3387
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003388 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3389 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3390
3391 Example :
3392 listen app_ip1
3393 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003394 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003395
3396 listen app_ip2
3397 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003398 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003399
3400 listen management
3401 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003402 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003403
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003404 listen management
3405 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3406 bind-process 1-4
3407
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003408 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003409
3410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411capture cookie <name> len <length>
3412 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 no | yes | yes | no
3415 Arguments :
3416 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3417 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3418 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3419 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003420 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003421
3422 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3423 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3424 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3425 right if it exceeds <length>.
3426
3427 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3428 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3429 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3430 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3431
3432 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3433 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3434 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3435
3436 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3437 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3438 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003439 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3440 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3441 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003442
3443 Example:
3444 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3445
3446 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003447 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003448
3449
3450capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003451 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3453 no | yes | yes | no
3454 Arguments :
3455 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003456 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003457 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3458 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3459 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3460
3461 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3462 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3463 it exceeds <length>.
3464
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003465 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3467 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003468 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3469 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3470 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3471 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003472 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003473 environments to find where the request came from.
3474
3475 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3476 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3477 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3478 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003479
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003480 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3481 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3482 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3483 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3484 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
3486 Example:
3487 capture request header Host len 15
3488 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003489 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003491 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492 about logging.
3493
3494
3495capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003496 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3498 no | yes | yes | no
3499 Arguments :
3500 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003501 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3503 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3504 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3505
3506 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3507 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3508 it exceeds <length>.
3509
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003510 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3512 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3513 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003514 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3515 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3516 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3517 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003519 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3520 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3521 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3522 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3523 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003524
3525 Example:
3526 capture response header Content-length len 9
3527 capture response header Location len 15
3528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003529 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530 about logging.
3531
3532
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003533compression algo <algorithm> ...
3534compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003535compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003536 Enable HTTP compression.
3537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3538 yes | yes | yes | yes
3539 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003540 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3541 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3542 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3543
3544 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003545 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3546 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3547 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003548
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003549 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003550 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003551
3552 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3553 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3554 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3555 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3556 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003557 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003558
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003559 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3560 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3561 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3562 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3563 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3564 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3565 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003566 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003567
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003568 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003569 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003570 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3571 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3572 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3573 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3574 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003575
3576 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3577 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3578 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3579 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3580 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003581 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3582 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3583 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3584 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3585 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003586 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3587 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003588
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003589 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003590 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3591 "Accept-Encoding" header
3592 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003593 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003594 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3595 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3596 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3597 "multipart"
3598 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3599 header
3600 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3601 and later
3602 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3603 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003604 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003605
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003606 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003607
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003608 Examples :
3609 compression algo gzip
3610 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003612
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003613cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003614 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3615 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003616 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3619 yes | no | yes | yes
3620 Arguments :
3621 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3622 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3623 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3624 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3625 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3626 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003627 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3629 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3630
3631 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3632 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3633 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3634 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3635 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3636 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003637 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3638 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003639 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003640 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3641 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003642
3643 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003644 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003645
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003646 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003647 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003648 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003649 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003650 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3651 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3652 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3653 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3654 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3655 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3656 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003657
3658 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3659 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3660 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3661 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3662 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3663 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3664 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3665 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3666 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003667 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003668 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3669 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3670 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003672 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3673 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3674 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003675 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3676 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3677 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3678 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003679 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3680 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3681 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682
3683 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3684 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3685 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3686 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3687 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3688 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3689 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3690 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3691 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3692
3693 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3694 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3695 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3696 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3697 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3698 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3699 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3700 persistence cookie in the cache.
3701 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3702
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003703 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3704 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3705 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3706 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3707 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003708 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003709 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3710 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3711 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3712 they logout.
3713
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003714 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3715 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3716 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3717 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3718
3719 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3720 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3721 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3722 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3723 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3724 this attribute.
3725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003726 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003727 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003728 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3729 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3730 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3731 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3732 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3733 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003734
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003735 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3736 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3737 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3738 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3739 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3740 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3741 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3742 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003743 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003744 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3745 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3746 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3747 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3748 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3749 the site.
3750
3751 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3752 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3753 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3754 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3755 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3756 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3757 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3758 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3759 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3760 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3761 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3762 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3763 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003764 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003765 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3766 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3767
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003768 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3769 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3770 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3771 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3772 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3773 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3774
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003775 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3776 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3777 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3778 repeated.
3779
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003780 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3781 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3782 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3783 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003784
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003785 Examples :
3786 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3787 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3788 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003789 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003791 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003792
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003793
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003794declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3795 Declares a capture slot.
3796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3797 no | yes | yes | no
3798 Arguments:
3799 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3800
3801 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3802 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3803 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3804 for use in the response.
3805
3806 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003807 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003808 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3809
3810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003811default-server [param*]
3812 Change default options for a server in a backend
3813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3814 yes | no | yes | yes
3815 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003816 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3817 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3818 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3819 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003820
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003821 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003822 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3823
3824 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003825
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003827default_backend <backend>
3828 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3830 yes | yes | yes | no
3831 Arguments :
3832 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3833
3834 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3835 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3836 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3837 will catch all undetermined requests.
3838
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003839 Example :
3840
3841 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3842 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3843 default_backend dynamic
3844
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003845 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003846
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003847
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003848description <string>
3849 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 no | yes | yes | yes
3852 Arguments : string
3853
3854 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3855 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3856 it describes.
3857 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3858
3859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003860disabled
3861 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | yes | yes | yes
3864 Arguments : none
3865
3866 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3867 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3868 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3869 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3870 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3871 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3872 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3873
3874 See also : "enabled"
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003877dispatch <address>:<port>
3878 Set a default server address
3879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003881 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003882
3883 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3884 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3885 during start-up.
3886
3887 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3888 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3889 possible with normal servers.
3890
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003891 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003892 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3893 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3894 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3895 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3896
3897 See also : "server"
3898
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003899
3900dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3901 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3903 yes | no | yes | yes
3904 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3905
3906 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003907 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003908 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3909 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003910 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003911 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003912
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003913enabled
3914 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | yes | yes | yes
3917 Arguments : none
3918
3919 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3920 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3921
3922 See also : "disabled"
3923
3924
3925errorfile <code> <file>
3926 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3928 yes | yes | yes | yes
3929 Arguments :
3930 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003931 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003932 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003933
3934 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003935 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003936 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003937 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3938 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003939
3940 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3941 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3942 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3943
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003944 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3945
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003946 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3947 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3948 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3949 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3950 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3951 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3952 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3953 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3954 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3957 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3958 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003959 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3961
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003962 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003963
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003964 Example :
3965 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003966 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003967 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3968 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3969
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003970
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003971errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3972 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3973 section.
3974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 yes | yes | yes | yes
3976 Arguments :
3977 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3978
3979 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003980 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003981 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003982
3983 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3984 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3985 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3986 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3987 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3988 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3989 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3990
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003991 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
3992 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003993
3994 Example :
3995 errorfiles generic
3996 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3997
3998
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003999errorloc <code> <url>
4000errorloc302 <code> <url>
4001 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4003 yes | yes | yes | yes
4004 Arguments :
4005 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004006 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004007 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004008
4009 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4010 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4011 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4012 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004013 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004014
4015 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4016 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4017 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4018
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004019 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4020
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004021 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4022 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4023 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4024 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004025 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004026 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4027 request.
4028
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004029 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004030
4031
4032errorloc303 <code> <url>
4033 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4035 yes | yes | yes | yes
4036 Arguments :
4037 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004038 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004039 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004040
4041 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4042 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4043 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4044 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004045 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004046
4047 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4048 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4049 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4050
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004051 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4052
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004053 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4054 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4055 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4056 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004057 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004058
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004059 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004060
4061
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004062email-alert from <emailaddr>
4063 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004064 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 yes | yes | yes | yes
4067
4068 Arguments :
4069
4070 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4071
4072 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4073 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4074
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004075 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004076 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4077 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004078
4079
4080email-alert level <level>
4081 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4082 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4083 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4084 yes | yes | yes | yes
4085
4086 Arguments :
4087
4088 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4089 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4090 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4091
4092 By default level is alert
4093
4094 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4095 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4096 for the proxy.
4097
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004098 Alerts are sent when :
4099
4100 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4101 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4102 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4103 is notice or lower
4104 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4105 and a health check status update occurs
4106
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004107 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4108 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004109 section 3.6 about mailers.
4110
4111
4112email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4113 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4115 yes | yes | yes | yes
4116
4117 Arguments :
4118
4119 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4120
4121 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4122 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4123
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004124 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4125 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004126
4127
4128email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4129 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4130 mailers.
4131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 yes | yes | yes | yes
4133
4134 Arguments :
4135
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004136 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004137
4138 By default the systems hostname is used.
4139
4140 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4141 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4142 for the proxy.
4143
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004144 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4145 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004146
4147
4148email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004149 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004150 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4152 yes | yes | yes | yes
4153
4154 Arguments :
4155
4156 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4157
4158 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4159 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4160
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004161 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004162 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4163
4164
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004165force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4166 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4167 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004168 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004169
4170 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4171 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4172 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4173 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4174 marked down for maintenance operations.
4175
4176 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4177 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4178 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4179 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4180 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4181 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4182 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4183 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4184 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4185
4186 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4187 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4188 is used.
4189
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004190 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004191 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004192
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004193
4194filter <name> [param*]
4195 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4197 no | yes | yes | yes
4198 Arguments :
4199 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4200 referenced in section 9.
4201
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004202 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004203 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004204 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4205 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004206
4207 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4208 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4209
4210 Example:
4211 listen
4212 bind *:80
4213
4214 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4215 filter compression
4216 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4217
4218 compression algo gzip
4219 compression offload
4220
4221 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4222
4223 See also : section 9.
4224
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004225
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004226fullconn <conns>
4227 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4229 yes | no | yes | yes
4230 Arguments :
4231 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4232 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4233
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004234 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004235 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004236 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004237 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4238 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4239 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4240 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4241 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004242 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004243
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004244 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4245 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004246 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4247 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4248 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004250 Example :
4251 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4252 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4253 # connections.
4254 backend dynamic
4255 fullconn 10000
4256 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4257 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4258
4259 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4260
4261
4262grace <time>
4263 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004265 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004266 Arguments :
4267 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4268 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4269 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4270
4271 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4272 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004273 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004274 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4275
4276 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4277 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4278 simplify it.
4279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004280
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004281hash-balance-factor <factor>
4282 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4284 yes | no | no | yes
4285 Arguments :
4286 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4287 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004288 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004289
4290 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4291 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4292 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4293 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4294 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4295 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4296 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4297
4298 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4299 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4300 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4301 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4302 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4303
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004304 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4305 consistent hashing mechanism.
4306
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004307 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4308
4309
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004310hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004311 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4313 yes | no | yes | yes
4314 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004315 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4316 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004317
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004318 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4319 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4320 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4321 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4322 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4323 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4324 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4325 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4326 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4327 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004328
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004329 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4330 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4331 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4332 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4333 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4334 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4335 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4336 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4337 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4338 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4339 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4340 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4341 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004342 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4343 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004344
4345 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4346
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004347 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004348 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4349 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4350 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004351 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4352 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4353 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004354
4355 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4356 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004357 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4358 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4359 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4360 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4361
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004362 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4363 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4364 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4365 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4366 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4367 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4368 parameter.
4369
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004370 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4371 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4372 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4373 used on strings.
4374
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004375 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4376
4377 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4378 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4379 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4380 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4381 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4382 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4383 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4384 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4385 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4386 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4387 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4388 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004389
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004390 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4391 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4392 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004393
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004394 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004395
4396
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004397http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4398 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4399 ones).
4400
4401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 no | yes | yes | yes
4403
4404 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4405 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4406 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4407 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4408 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4409 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4410
4411 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4412 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4413 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4414
4415 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4416 below.
4417
4418 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4419 instance.
4420
4421 Example:
4422 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4423 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4424 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4425
4426http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4427
4428 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4429 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4430 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4431 example, or to pass some internal information.
4432 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4433 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4434 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4435
4436http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4437
4438 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4439 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4440
4441http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4442
4443 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4444
4445http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4447
4448 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4449
4450 Example:
4451 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4452
4453 # applied to:
4454 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4455
4456 # outputs:
4457 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4458
4459 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4460
4461http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4462 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4463
4464 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4465
4466 Example:
4467 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4468
4469 # applied to:
4470 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4471
4472 # outputs:
4473 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4474
4475http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4476
4477 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4478 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4479 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4480
4481http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4482 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4483
4484 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4485 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4486 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4487 fallback.
4488
4489 Example:
4490 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4491 http-response set-status 431
4492 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4493 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4494
4495http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4496
4497 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4498 inline.
4499
4500 Arguments:
4501 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4502 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4503 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4504 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4505 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4506 (request and response)
4507 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4508 processing
4509 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4510 processing
4511 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4512 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4513 and '_'.
4514
4515 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4516 followed by some converters.
4517
4518 Example:
4519 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4520
4521http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4522
4523 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4524 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4525 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4526 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4527 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004528 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004529 processing.
4530
4531 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4532 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4533 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4534 rules evaluation.
4535
4536http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4537
4538 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4539 details about <var-name>.
4540
4541 Example:
4542 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4543
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004544
4545http-check comment <string>
4546 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4547 it fails.
4548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4549 yes | no | yes | yes
4550
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004551 Arguments :
4552 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4553 rule fails.
4554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004555 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4556 user-friendly error reporting.
4557
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004558 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4559 "http-check expect".
4560
4561
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004562http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4563 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004564 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004565 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4567 yes | no | yes | yes
4568
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004569 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004570 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4571
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004572 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4573 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4574
4575 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4576 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4577 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4578 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4579
4580 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4581
4582 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4583
4584 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4585
4586 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4587
4588 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4589
4590 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4591 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4592 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4593 is used.
4594
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004595 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4596 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4597 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4598 haproxy -vv.
4599
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004600 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4601
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004602 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4603 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4604 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4605 different ports or with different servers.
4606
4607 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4608 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4609 the port with a "http-check connect".
4610
4611 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4612 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4613 do.
4614
4615 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4616 unset-var or comment rules.
4617
4618 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004619 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4620 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4621 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4622 option httpchk
4623
4624 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004625 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004626 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004627 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004628 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004629 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004630
4631 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4632
4633 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004634
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004635
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004636http-check disable-on-404
4637 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004639 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004640 Arguments : none
4641
4642 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4643 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4644 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4645 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4646 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4647 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4648 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4649 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004650 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4651 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4652 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4653
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004654 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004655
4656
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004657http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004658 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4659 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4660 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004661 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004663 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004664
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004665 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004666 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4667
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004668 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4669 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4670 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4671 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4672 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4673 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4674 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4675 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4676 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4677 result is always conclusive.
4678
4679 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4680 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4681 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004682 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4683 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4684 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4685 example 404 with disable-on-404
4686 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4687 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4688 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004689
4690 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4691 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004692 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4693 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4694 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4695 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4696 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4697 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004698
4699 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4700 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004701 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4702 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4703 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4704 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004705 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4706
4707 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4708 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4709 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4710 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4711
4712 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4713 informational message reported in logs if an error
4714 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4715 log-format string.
4716
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004717 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004718 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4719 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004720 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4721 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4722 details on the supported keywords.
4723
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004724 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4725 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4726 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4727 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004728
4729 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4730 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4731 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4732 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4733 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4734
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004735 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4736 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4737 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4738 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4739 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4740 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4741 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004742
4743 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004744 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004745 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4746 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4747 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4748 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4749
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004750 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4751 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004752 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4753 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4754 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4755 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4756 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4757 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4758 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4759 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004760 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4761 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4762 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4763 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4764 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4765 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4766 insensitive on the header names.
4767
4768 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4769 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4770 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4771 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4772 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4773 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004774
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004775 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004776 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004777 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4778 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4779 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4780 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4781 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004782 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004783 trace).
4784
4785 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004786 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004787 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4788 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4789 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4790 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4791 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004792 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004793
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004794 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4795 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4796 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4797 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4798 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4799 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4800
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004801 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4802 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4803 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4804 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4805 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4806 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4807 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4808 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4809
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004810 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4811 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4812 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4813 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4814 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004815
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004816 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4817 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4818
4819 Examples :
4820 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004821 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004822
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004823 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4824 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4825
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004826 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004827 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004828
4829 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004830 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004831
4832 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004833 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004834
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004835 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004836 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004837
4838
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004839http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004840 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4841 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004842 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4843 health checks.
4844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 yes | no | yes | yes
4846 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004847 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4848
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004849 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4850 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4851 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4852 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4853 to invent non-standard ones.
4854
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004855 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4856 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4857 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4858 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4859
4860 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4861 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4862 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4863 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004864
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004865 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004866 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4867 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4868 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4869 to add it.
4870
4871 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4872 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4873 to the log-format rules.
4874
4875 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4876 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4877 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004878
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004879 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4880 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4881 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4882 request.
4883
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004884 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4885 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4886 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004887 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4888 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4889 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4890 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004891 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4892 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4893 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4894
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004895 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4896 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004897 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4898 so, it will be ignored.
4899
4900 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4901 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4902 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4903 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4904 configured request authority.
4905
4906 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4907 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004908
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004909 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004910
4911
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004912http-check send-state
4913 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | no | yes | yes
4916 Arguments : none
4917
4918 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4919 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4920 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4921 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4922 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4923
4924 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4925 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4926 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4927 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4928 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004929 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4930 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4931 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4932
4933 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4934 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4935 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4936
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004937 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4938 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4939 checked in multiple backends.
4940
4941 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4942 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4943
4944 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4945 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4946 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4947 one fails.
4948
4949 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4950 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4951 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4952
4953 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4954 server's queue.
4955
4956 Example of a header received by the application server :
4957 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4958 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4959
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004960 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4961 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004962
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004963
4964http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004965 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004966 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4967 yes | no | yes | yes
4968
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004969 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004970 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4971 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4972 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4973 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4974 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4975 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4976 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4977 and '-'.
4978
4979 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4980
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004981 Examples :
4982 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004983
4984
4985http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004986 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4988 yes | no | yes | yes
4989
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004990 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004991 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4992 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4993 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4994 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4995 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4996 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4997 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4998 and '-'.
4999
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005000 Examples :
5001 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005003
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005004http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5005 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5006 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5007 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5008 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 yes | yes | yes | yes
5011 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005012 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005013 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005014 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5015 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005016
5017 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5018 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5019 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5020 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5021
5022 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5023 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5024 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5025 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5026
5027 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5028 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5029 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5030 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5031 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5032 chroot is performed.
5033
5034 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5035 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5036 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5037 considered.
5038
5039 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5040 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5041 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5042 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5043 considered as a raw string.
5044
5045 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5046 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5047 "content-type".
5048
5049 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5050 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5051 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5052 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5053 evaluated as a log-format string.
5054
5055 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5056 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5057 argument to "content-type".
5058
5059 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5060 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5061 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5062 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5063
5064 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5065 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5066 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5067 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5068 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5069 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5070 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5071 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5072
5073 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5074 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5075 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5076
5077 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5078 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5079
5080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005081http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005082 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5083
5084 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5085 no | yes | yes | yes
5086
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005087 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5088 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5089 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5090 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5091 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005093 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5094 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005098 Example:
5099 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5100 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5101 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005103 http-request allow if nagios
5104 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5105 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5106 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005108 Example:
5109 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5110 acl add path /addacl
5111 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005113 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005115 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5116 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005118 Example:
5119 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5120 acl setmap path /setmap
5121 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005123 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005125 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5126 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005128 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5129 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005131http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005133 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5134 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5135 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5136 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5137 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5138 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5139 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5140 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005142http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005144 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5145 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5146 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5147 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5148 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5149 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5150 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5151 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005153http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005155 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5156 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005157
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005159http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005161 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5162 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5163 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5164 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5165 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005166
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005167 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5168 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5169 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5170 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5171 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5172 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5173 instead.
5174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005175 Example:
5176 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5177 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005178
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005179http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005180
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005181 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005183http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5184 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005186 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5187 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5188 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5189 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5190 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5191 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5192 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5193 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5194 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005196 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5197 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5198 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005199 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5200
5201 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5202 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5203 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5204 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005206http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005208 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5209 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5210 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5211 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5212 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5213 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005215http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005217 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005219http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005221 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5222 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5223 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5224 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5225 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5226 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005227
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005228http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5229http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5230 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5231 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5232 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5233 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005234
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005235 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5236 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5237 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005238 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005239 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5240 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5241 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005242 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005243 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005244
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005245http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5246 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5247 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5248 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5249
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005250http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5251
5252 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5253 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5254 pointed by <resolvers>.
5255 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5256 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5257 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5258 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5259 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5260 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5261 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5262 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5263 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5264 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5265 to 0.0.0.0.
5266
5267 Example:
5268 resolvers mydns
5269 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5270 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5271 timeout retry 1s
5272 hold valid 10s
5273 hold nx 3s
5274 hold other 3s
5275 hold obsolete 0s
5276 accepted_payload_size 8192
5277
5278 frontend fe
5279 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5280 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5281 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5282
5283 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5284 # which mean DNS resolution error
5285 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5286
5287 default_backend be
5288
5289 backend b_503
5290 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5291 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5292 # 503 error page to end users
5293
5294 backend be
5295 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5296 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5297 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5298 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5299 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5300
5301 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5302 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5303
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005304http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5305
5306 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5307 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5308 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5309 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005310 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5311 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005312
5313 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005315http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005317 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5318 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5319 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5320 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5321 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005323http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005325 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5326 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5327 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5328 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005330http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5331 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005332
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005333 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005334 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5335 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5336 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5337 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5338 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005339
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005340 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5341 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5342 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5343 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5344 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005345
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005346 Example:
5347 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5348
5349 # applied to:
5350 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5351
5352 # outputs:
5353 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5354
5355 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005356
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005357 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5358
5359 # applied to:
5360 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005361
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005362 # outputs:
5363 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005364
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005365http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5367
5368 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5369 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5370 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5371 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5372
5373 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5374 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5375 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5376
5377 Example:
5378 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5379 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5380
5381 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5382 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5383
5384 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5385 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5386 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5387 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5388
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005389http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5390 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5391
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005392 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5393 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5394 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5395 against.
5396
5397 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5398 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5399 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005400
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005401 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5402 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5403 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5404 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5405 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5406 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5407 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5408 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5409 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005410 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5411 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005412
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005413 Example:
5414 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5415 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005416
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005417 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5418 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005420http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5421 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005422
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005423 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5424 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5425 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5426 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005427
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005428 Example:
5429 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005430
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005431 # applied to:
5432 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005433
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005434 # outputs:
5435 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005436
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005437http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5438 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5439 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005440 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005441 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5442
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005443 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005444 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5445 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5446 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5447 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005448 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005449 are followed to create the response :
5450
5451 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5452 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5453 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5454 ignored.
5455
5456 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5457 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005458 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
5459 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5460 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005461
5462 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5463 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5464 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005465 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
5466 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005467
5468 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5469 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5470 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5471 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005472 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5473 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005474
5475 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5476 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5477 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5478 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5479 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5480 as a raw content.
5481
5482 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5483 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5484 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5485 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5486 considered as a raw string.
5487
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005488 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5489 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5490 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5491 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5492
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005493 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5494 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005495 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005496
5497 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5498
5499 Example:
5500 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5501 if { path /ping }
5502
5503 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5504 if { path /favicon.ico }
5505
5506 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5507 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5508 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005510http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5511http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005513 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5514 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5515 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005516
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005517http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5518 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005519
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005520 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5521 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5522 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5523 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005525http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005527 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5528 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5529 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5530 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5531 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005533 Arguments:
5534 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5535 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005537 Example:
5538 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5539 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005541 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5542 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005544http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005546 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5547 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5548 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005550 Arguments:
5551 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5552 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005554 Example:
5555 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5556 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005558 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5559 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5560 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005562http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005564 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5565 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5566 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5567 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5568 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005570 Example:
5571 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5572 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5573 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5574 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5575 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5576 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5577 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5578 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5579 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005581http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005583 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5584 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5585 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5586 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5587 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005589http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5590 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005592 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5593 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5594 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5595 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5596 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5597 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5598 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5599 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5600 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005604 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5605 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5606 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5607 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5608 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5609 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5610 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005614 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5615 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5616 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005618http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005620 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5621 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5622 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5623 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5624 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5625 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5626 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5627 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005629http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005631 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5632 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5633 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5634 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5635 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5636 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005638 Example :
5639 # prepend the host name before the path
5640 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005642http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005644 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5645 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5646 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5647 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5648 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005650http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005652 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5653 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5654 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5655 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5656 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5657 values have higher priority.
5658 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5659 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5660 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5661 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5662 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005664http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005666 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5667 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5668 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5669 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5670 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5671 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5672 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005674 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005675
5676 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005677 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5678 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005680http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5681 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5682 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5683 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005684 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5685 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005686
5687 Arguments :
5688 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5689 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005690
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005691 See also "option forwardfor".
5692
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005693 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005694 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5695 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5696
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005697 # After the masking this will track connections
5698 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5699 http-request track-sc0 src
5700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005701 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5702 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5703
5704http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5705
5706 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5707 expression.
5708
5709 Arguments:
5710 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5711 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005712
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005713 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005714 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5715 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5716
5717 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5718 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5719 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5720
5721http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5722
5723 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5724 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5725 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5726 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5727 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5728 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5729 information from the request.
5730
5731 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5732
5733http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5734
5735 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5736 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5737 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5738 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5739 path and the query string.
5740 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5741
5742http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5743
5744 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5745 inline.
5746
5747 Arguments:
5748 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5749 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5750 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5751 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5752 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5753 (request and response)
5754 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5755 processing
5756 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5757 processing
5758 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5759 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5760 and '_'.
5761
5762 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5763 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005764
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005765 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005766 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005768http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5769 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005771 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5772 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5773 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5774 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5775 agent name must be used.
5776
5777 Arguments:
5778 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5779
5780 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5781 configuration.
5782
5783http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5784
5785 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5786 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5787 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5788 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5789 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5790 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5791 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5792 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5793 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5794 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5795 action.
5796 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5797 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5798 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5799 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5800 you fully understand how it works.
5801
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005802http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5803
5804 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5805 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5806 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5807 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5808 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005809 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005810 processing.
5811
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005812 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005813 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5814 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5815 rules evaluation.
5816
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005817http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5818http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5819 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5820 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5821 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5822 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823
5824 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5825 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5826 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005827 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5828 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5829 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5830 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5831 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5832 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5833 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5834 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5835 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5836 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005837 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005838 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5839 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5840 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5841 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5842 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005843
5844http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5845http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5846http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5847
5848 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5849 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5850 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5851 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5852 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5853 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5854 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5855 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5856 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5857 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5858 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5859 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5860
5861 Arguments :
5862 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5863 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5864 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5865 select which table entry to update the counters.
5866
5867 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5868 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5869 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5870 that table until the session ends.
5871
5872 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5873 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5874 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5875 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5876 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5877 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5878 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5879 useful information.
5880
5881 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5882 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5883 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5884 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5885 checks that make use of it.
5886
5887http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5888
5889 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005890
5891 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005892 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005893
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005894http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5895
5896 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5897 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5898 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5899 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5900 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5901 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5902
5903 Arguments :
5904 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5905
5906 Example:
5907 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005909http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5912 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5913 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005914
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005916http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005917 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5918
5919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 no | yes | yes | yes
5921
5922 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5923 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5924 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5925 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5926 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5927 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005929 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5930 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005932 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005934 Example:
5935 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005937 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005939 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5940 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005942 Example:
5943 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005945 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005947 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5948 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005950 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5951 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005953http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005955 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5956 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5957 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5958 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5959 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5960 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5961 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5962 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005964http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005966 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5967 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5968 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5969 example, or to pass some internal information.
5970 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5971 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5972 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005974http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005976 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5977 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005978
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005979http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005980
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005981 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005983http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005985 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5986 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5987 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5988 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5989 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5990 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5991 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005993 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5994 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5995 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5996 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5997 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005998
5999 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6000 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6001 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6002 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006003
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006004http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006006 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6007 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6008 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6009 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6010 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6011 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006013http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006015 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006017http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006019 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6020 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6021 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6022 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6023 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6024 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006025
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006026http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6027http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6028 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6029 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6030 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6031 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006032
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006033 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6034 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6035 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006036 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006037 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6038 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6039 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006040 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006041 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006043http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006045 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6046 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6047 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6048 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6049 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6050 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006052http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6053 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006054
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006055 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6056 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006058 Example:
6059 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006061 # applied to:
6062 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006064 # outputs:
6065 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006067 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006069http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6070 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006071
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006072 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006073 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006075 Example:
6076 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006078 # applied to:
6079 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006081 # outputs:
6082 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006083
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006084http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6085 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6086 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006087 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006088 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6089
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006090 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006091 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6092 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
6093 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
6094 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006095 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006096 are followed to create the response :
6097
6098 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6099 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6100 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6101 ignored.
6102
6103 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6104 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006105 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
6106 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6107 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006108
6109 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6110 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6111 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006112 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
6113 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006114
6115 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6116 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6117 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
6118 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006119 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6120 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006121
6122 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6123 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6124 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6125 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6126 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6127 as a raw content.
6128
6129 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6130 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6131 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6132 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6133 considered as a raw string.
6134
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006135 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6136 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6137 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6138 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6139
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006140 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6141 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006142 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006143
6144 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6145
6146 Example:
6147 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
6148 if { status eq 404 }
6149
6150 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6151 string "This is the end !" \
6152 if { status eq 500 }
6153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006154http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6155http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006156
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006157 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6158 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6159 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006160
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006161http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6162 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006163
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006164 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6165 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6166 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6167 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006169http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006171 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6172 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6173 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6174 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6175 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006177 Arguments:
6178 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006180 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6181 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006183http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006185 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6186 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6187 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006189http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6190
6191 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6192 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6193 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6194 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6195 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6196
6197http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6198
6199 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6200 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6201 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6202 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6203 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6204 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6205 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6206 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6207 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6208
6209http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6210
6211 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6212 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6213 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6214 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6215 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6216 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6217 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6218
6219http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6220
6221 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6222 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6223 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6224 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6225 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6226 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6227 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6228 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6229
6230http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6231 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6232
6233 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6234 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6235 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6236 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006237
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006238 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006239 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6240 http-response set-status 431
6241 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6242 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006244http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006246 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6247 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6248 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6249 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6250 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6251 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6252 based on some information from the request.
6253
6254 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6255
6256http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6257
6258 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6259 inline.
6260
6261 Arguments:
6262 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6263 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6264 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6265 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6266 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6267 (request and response)
6268 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6269 processing
6270 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6271 processing
6272 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6273 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6274 and '_'.
6275
6276 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6277 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006278
6279 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006280 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006282http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006284 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6285 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6286 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6287 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6288 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6289 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6290 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6291 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6292 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6293 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6294 action.
6295 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6296 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6297 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6298 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6299 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006300
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006301http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6302
6303 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6304 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6305 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6306 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6307 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006308 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006309 processing.
6310
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006311 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006312 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6313 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6314 rules evaluation.
6315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006316http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6317http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6318http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006319
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006320 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6321 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6322 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6323 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6324 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6325 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6326
6327http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6328
6329 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6330 about <var-name>.
6331
6332 Example:
6333 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6334
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006335
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006336http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6337 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6338
6339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6340 yes | no | yes | yes
6341
6342 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006343 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6344 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6345 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006346
6347 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6348
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006349 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6350 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6351 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6352 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6353 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6354 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6355 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6356 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6357 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6358 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006359
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006360 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6361 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6362 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6363 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6364 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6365 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6366 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6367 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006368
6369 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6370 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6371 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6372 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6373 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6374 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6375 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6376 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006377 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006378 downsides of rare connection failures.
6379
6380 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6381 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6382 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6383 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6384 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6385 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006386 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006387 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6388 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6389 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6390 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6391 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6392
6393 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006394 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6395 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6396 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006397
6398 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006399 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006400
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006401 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6402 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006403
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006404 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006405
6406 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6407 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6408 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6409
6410 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6411
6412
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006413http-send-name-header [<header>]
6414 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006415 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6416 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006417 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006418 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6419
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006420 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6421 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6422 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6423 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6424 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6425 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6426 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6427 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6428 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6429 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6430 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6431 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6432 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6433 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6434 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6435 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006436
6437 See also : "server"
6438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006439id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006440 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 no | yes | yes | yes
6443 Arguments : none
6444
6445 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6446 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6447 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006448
6449
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006450ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6451 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6452 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006453 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006454
6455 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6456 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6457 and running).
6458
6459 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6460 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6461 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006462 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006463 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6464
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006465 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6466 "unless" condition is met.
6467
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006468 Example:
6469 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6470 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6471 ignore-persist if url_static
6472
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006473 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6474
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006475load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6476 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6478 yes | no | yes | yes
6479
6480 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6481 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6482 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006483 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006484 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6485 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6486 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6487 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006489 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006490 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006491 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006492
6493 Arguments:
6494 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6495 named "server-state-file".
6496
6497 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6498 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6499 name is used as a file name.
6500
6501 none don't load any stat for this backend
6502
6503 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006504 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6505 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6506 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006507 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006508 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006509
6510 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6511 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6512
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006513 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006514
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006515 global
6516 stats socket /tmp/socket
6517 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006518
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006519 defaults
6520 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006521
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006522 backend bk
6523 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6524 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006525
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006526
6527 Then one can run :
6528
6529 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6530
6531 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6532
6533 1
6534 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6535 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6536 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6537
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006538 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006539
6540 global
6541 stats socket /tmp/socket
6542 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6543
6544 defaults
6545 load-server-state-from-file local
6546
6547 backend bk
6548 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6549 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6550
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006551
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006552 Then one can run :
6553
6554 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6555
6556 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6557
6558 1
6559 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6560 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6561 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6562
6563 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6564 "show servers state"
6565
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006566
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006567log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006568log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6569 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006570no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006571 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006574
6575 Prefix :
6576 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6577 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6578 prefix does not allow arguments.
6579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006580 Arguments :
6581 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6582 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6583 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6584 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6585 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6586 parameter.
6587
6588 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6589 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6590
6591 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6592 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6593 standard syslog port).
6594
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006595 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6596 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6597 standard syslog port).
6598
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006599 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6600 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6601 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006602 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006603
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006604 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6605 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6606 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6607 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6608 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6609 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6610 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6611 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6612 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6613 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6614 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6615 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6616 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6617 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6618 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6619 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006620 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6621 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006622
6623 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6624 and "fd@2", see above.
6625
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006626 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6627 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6628 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6629 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6630 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6631 having the logs instantly available.
6632
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006633 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6634 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006635
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006636 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6637 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6638 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6639 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6640 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6641 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6642 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6643 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6644 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6645 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006646 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006647
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006648 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6649 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6650 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6651 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6652 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6653
6654 <sample_size>
6655 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6656 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6657 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6658 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6659 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6660
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006661 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6662 one of the following :
6663
6664 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6665 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6666
6667 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6668 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6669
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006670 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6671 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6672 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6673 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6674 systemd logger consumes.
6675
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006676 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6677 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6678 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6679 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6680
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006681 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6682
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006683 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6684 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6685 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6686
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006687 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6688 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6689 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6690 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006691
6692 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6693 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6694 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006695 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6696 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6697 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6698 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6699 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006700
6701 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6702
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006703 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6704 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6705 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006706
6707 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6708 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6709 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6710 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6711
6712 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6713 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006714
6715 Example :
6716 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006717 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6718 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6719 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006720 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6721 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006722 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006723
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006724
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006725log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006726 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6727 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6728 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006729
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006730 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6731 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6732 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6733 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6734 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006735
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006736 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6737 "option httplog" directives.
6738
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006739log-format-sd <string>
6740 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6742 yes | yes | yes | no
6743
6744 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6745 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6746 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6747 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6748 which covers the log format string in depth.
6749
6750 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6751 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6752
6753 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6754 log format to "rfc5424".
6755
6756 Example :
6757 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6758
6759
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006760log-tag <string>
6761 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | yes | yes | yes
6764
6765 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6766 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6767 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6768 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6769 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6770 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6771 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6772 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6773 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006774
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006775max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6776 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 yes | no | yes | yes
6779
6780 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6781 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6782 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6783 servers.
6784
6785 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6786 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6787 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6788 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6789 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006790 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006791 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6792 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6793 picking a different server.
6794
6795 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6796 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6797 even if they have to be queued.
6798
6799 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6800 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6801
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006802max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6803 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6804 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6805 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006806
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006807maxconn <conns>
6808 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6810 yes | yes | yes | no
6811 Arguments :
6812 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6813 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6814 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6815 closes.
6816
6817 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6818 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6819 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6820 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006821 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6822 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6823 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6824 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006825
6826 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6827 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6828 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6829
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006830 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6831 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006833 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6834
6835
6836mode { tcp|http|health }
6837 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6839 yes | yes | yes | yes
6840 Arguments :
6841 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6842 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6843 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6844 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6845
6846 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6847 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6848 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6849 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6850 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6851
6852 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006853 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6854 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6855 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6856 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6857 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6858 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6859 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006860
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006861 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6862 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6863 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006864
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006865 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006866 defaults http_instances
6867 mode http
6868
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006869 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006871
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006872monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006873 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006876 Arguments :
6877 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6878 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006879 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006880 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6881 backend and its backup.
6882
6883 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6884 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6885 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6886 servers in a list of backends.
6887
6888 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6889 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6890 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6891 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6892 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6893 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6894 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006895 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6896 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006897
6898 Example:
6899 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006900 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006901 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6902 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6903 monitor-uri /site_alive
6904 monitor fail if site_dead
6905
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006906 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006907
6908
6909monitor-net <source>
6910 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6912 yes | yes | yes | no
6913 Arguments :
6914 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6915 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6916 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6917 followed by a mask.
6918
6919 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6920 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006921 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006922 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6923
6924 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6925 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6926 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6927 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006928 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6929 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6930 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006931
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006932 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6933 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6934 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6935 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6936 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6937 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006938
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006939 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6940 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006941
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006942 Example :
6943 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6944 frontend www
6945 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6946
6947 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6948
6949
6950monitor-uri <uri>
6951 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6953 yes | yes | yes | no
6954 Arguments :
6955 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6956 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6957
6958 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6959 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6960 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6961 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6962 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6963 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6964 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6965 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6966
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006967 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006968 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6969 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6970 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6971 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6972 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6973 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006974
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006975 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6976 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6977 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6978 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6979
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006980 Example :
6981 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6982 frontend www
6983 mode http
6984 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6985
6986 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6987
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006988
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006989option abortonclose
6990no option abortonclose
6991 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6993 yes | no | yes | yes
6994 Arguments : none
6995
6996 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6997 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6998 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6999 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007000 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007001 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7002 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7003 encountered while delivering the response.
7004
7005 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7006 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7007 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7008 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7009 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7010 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007011 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007012 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007013 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007014 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7015 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7016 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7017
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007018 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7019 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007020 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7021 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7022 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7023 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7024 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7025 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007026 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007027
7028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7030
7031 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7032
7033
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007034option accept-invalid-http-request
7035no option accept-invalid-http-request
7036 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7038 yes | yes | yes | no
7039 Arguments : none
7040
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007041 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007042 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007043 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007044 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7045 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7046 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7047 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7048 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007049 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7050 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7051 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7052 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007053 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007054 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007055 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7056 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7057 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007058
7059 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7060 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7061 been confirmed.
7062
7063 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7064 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007065 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7066 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007067 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7068
7069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7071
7072 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7073 stats socket.
7074
7075
7076option accept-invalid-http-response
7077no option accept-invalid-http-response
7078 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7080 yes | no | yes | yes
7081 Arguments : none
7082
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007083 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007084 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007085 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007086 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7087 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7088 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7089 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7090 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007091 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7092 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7093 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007094
7095 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7096 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7097 been confirmed.
7098
7099 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7100 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7101 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7102 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7103
7104 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7105 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7106
7107 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7108 stats socket.
7109
7110
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007111option allbackups
7112no option allbackups
7113 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7115 yes | no | yes | yes
7116 Arguments : none
7117
7118 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7119 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7120 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7121 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7122 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7123 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7124 order between the backup servers anymore.
7125
7126 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7127 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7128
7129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7131
7132
7133option checkcache
7134no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007135 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7137 yes | no | yes | yes
7138 Arguments : none
7139
7140 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7141 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007142 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007143 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7144 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007145 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007146
7147 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007148 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007149 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007150 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7151 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007152 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007153 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007154 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7155 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007156 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007157 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7158 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007159 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007160 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7161 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7162 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7163 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7164 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7165 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7166 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7167 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7168 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7169
7170 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007171 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7172 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7173 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7174 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007175
7176 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7177 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007178 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007179 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007180
7181 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7182 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7183
7184
7185option clitcpka
7186no option clitcpka
7187 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7189 yes | yes | yes | no
7190 Arguments : none
7191
7192 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7193 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007194 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007195 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7196
7197 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7198 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7199 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7200 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7201
7202 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7203 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7204 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7205 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7206 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7207
7208 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7209
7210 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7211 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7212 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7213
7214 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7215 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7216
7217 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7218
7219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007220option contstats
7221 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7223 yes | yes | yes | no
7224 Arguments : none
7225
7226 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7227 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7228 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7229 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007230 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7231 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7232 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7233 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7234 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007235
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007236option disable-h2-upgrade
7237no option disable-h2-upgrade
7238 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7239 connection.
7240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7241 yes | yes | yes | no
7242 Arguments : none
7243
7244 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7245 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7246 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7247 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7248 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7249 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7250 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7251 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7252
7253 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7254 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007255
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007256option dontlog-normal
7257no option dontlog-normal
7258 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7260 yes | yes | yes | no
7261 Arguments : none
7262
7263 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7264 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7265 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7266 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7267 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7268 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7269 logged.
7270
7271 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7272 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7273 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007275 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007276 logging.
7277
7278
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007279option dontlognull
7280no option dontlognull
7281 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7283 yes | yes | yes | no
7284 Arguments : none
7285
7286 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7287 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7288 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7289 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7290 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7291 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007292 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7293 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7294 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007295
7296 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007297 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007298 would not be logged.
7299
7300 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7301 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7302
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007303 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7304 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007305
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007306
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007307option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007308 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7310 yes | yes | yes | yes
7311 Arguments :
7312 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7313 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007314 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007315 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007316
7317 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7318 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7319 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7320 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7321 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7322 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7323 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007324 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7325 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7326 possible that the client has already brought one.
7327
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007328 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007329 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007330 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007331 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007332 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007333 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007334
7335 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7336 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7337 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7338 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7339 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7340 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7341 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7342
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007343 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7344 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7345 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7346 are under the control of the end-user.
7347
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007348 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007349 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7350 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007351 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7352 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7353 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007354
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007355 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007356 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7357 frontend www
7358 mode http
7359 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7360
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007361 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7362 backend www
7363 mode http
7364 option forwardfor header X-Client
7365
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007366 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007367 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007368
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007369
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007370option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7371no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7372 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | yes | yes | no
7375 Arguments : none
7376
7377 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7378 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7379 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7380 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7381 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7382 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7383 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7384
7385 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7386 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7387 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7388 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7389 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7390 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7391 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7392 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7393 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7394 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7395
7396 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7397
7398 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7399 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7400
7401 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7402 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7403
7404
7405option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7406no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7407 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 yes | no | yes | yes
7410 Arguments : none
7411
7412 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7413 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7414 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7415 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7416 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7417 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7418 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7419
7420 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7421 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7422 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7423 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7424 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7425 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7426 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7427 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7428 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7429 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7430
7431 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7432
7433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7435
7436 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7437 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7438
7439
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007440option http-buffer-request
7441no option http-buffer-request
7442 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7444 yes | yes | yes | yes
7445 Arguments : none
7446
7447 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7448 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7449 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7450 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7451 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7452 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007453 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7454 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7455 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7456 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007457
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007458 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007459
7460
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007461option http-ignore-probes
7462no option http-ignore-probes
7463 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7465 yes | yes | yes | no
7466 Arguments : none
7467
7468 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7469 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7470 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7471 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7472 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7473 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7474 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7475 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7476 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007477 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7478 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007479 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7480
7481 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7482 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7483 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7484 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7485 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7486 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7487 are often the only way to detect them.
7488
7489 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7490 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7491
7492 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7493
7494
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007495option http-keep-alive
7496no option http-keep-alive
7497 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7499 yes | yes | yes | yes
7500 Arguments : none
7501
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007502 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7503 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007504 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7505 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007506 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7507 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7508 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007509
7510 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7511 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007512 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7513 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7514 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7515 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7516 situations where this option may be useful :
7517
7518 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007519 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007520
7521 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7522 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7523
7524 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7525 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7526 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7527 request.
7528
7529 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7530 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007531 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7532 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7533 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007534
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007535 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7536 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7537 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7538 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7539 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7540 not set.
7541
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007542 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7543 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7544 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007545
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007546 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007547 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007548 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007549
7550
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007551option http-no-delay
7552no option http-no-delay
7553 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7555 yes | yes | yes | yes
7556 Arguments : none
7557
7558 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7559 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7560 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7561 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7562 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7563 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7564 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7565 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7566 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7567 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7568 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7569 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7570 affected.
7571
7572 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7573 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7574 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7575 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7576 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7577 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7578 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7579 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7580 latency environments.
7581
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007582 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7583
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007584
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007585option http-pretend-keepalive
7586no option http-pretend-keepalive
7587 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007589 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007590 Arguments : none
7591
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007592 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007593 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7594 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7595 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7596 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7597 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7598 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7599 consider the response complete.
7600
7601 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7602 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7603 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7604 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007605 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007606 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7607
7608 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7609 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7610 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7611 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7612 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7613 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7614 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7615
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007616 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7617 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7618 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7619 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7620 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7621 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007622
7623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7625
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007626 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007627 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007628
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007629
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007630option http-server-close
7631no option http-server-close
7632 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7634 yes | yes | yes | yes
7635 Arguments : none
7636
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007637 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7638 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7639 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7640 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007641 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7642 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7643 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7644 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7645 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7646 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7647 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7648 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7649 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7650 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7651 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007652
7653 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7654 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7655 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7656 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007657 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7658 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007659
7660 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7661 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007662 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7663 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7664 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007665
7666 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7667 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7668
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007669 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7670 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007671
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007672option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007673no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007674 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7676 yes | yes | yes | no
7677 Arguments : none
7678
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007679 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007680 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7681 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7682 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7683 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7684 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7685 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7686
7687 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7688 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007689 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7690 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7691 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007692
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007693 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7694 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7695 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7696 front of an existing proxy.
7697
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007698 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7699
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007700 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007701
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007702option httpchk
7703option httpchk <uri>
7704option httpchk <method> <uri>
7705option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007706 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7708 yes | no | yes | yes
7709 Arguments :
7710 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7711 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7712 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7713 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7714 ones.
7715
7716 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7717 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7718 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7719
7720 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7721 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7722 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007723 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007724
7725 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7726 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7727 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7728 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7729 the lack of any response.
7730
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007731 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7732 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7733 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7734 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7735
7736 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7737 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7738 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007739
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007740 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7741 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007742 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7743 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7744 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007745
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007746 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7747 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7748 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7749 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7750
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007751 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007752 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7753 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7754 backend https_relay
7755 mode tcp
7756 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7757 http-check send hdr Host www
7758 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007759
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007760 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7761 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7762 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007763
7764
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007765option httpclose
7766no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007767 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7769 yes | yes | yes | yes
7770 Arguments : none
7771
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007772 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7773 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7774 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7775 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007776 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007777
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007778 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7779 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007780 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007781 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7782 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007783
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007784 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7785 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7786 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007787
7788 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7789 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007790 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7791 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7792 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007793
7794 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7795 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7796
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007797 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007798
7799
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007800option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007801 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007803 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007804 Arguments :
7805 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7806 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7807 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007808 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007809 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007810
7811 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7812 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7813 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7814 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7815 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7816 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7817 ports.
7818
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007819 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7820 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007821
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007822 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007824 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007825
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007826
7827option http_proxy
7828no option http_proxy
7829 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7831 yes | yes | yes | yes
7832 Arguments : none
7833
7834 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7835 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7836 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7837 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7838 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7839
7840 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7841 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007842 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7843 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007844
7845 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7846 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7847
7848 Example :
7849 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7850 backend direct_forward
7851 option httpclose
7852 option http_proxy
7853
7854 See also : "option httpclose"
7855
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007856
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007857option independent-streams
7858no option independent-streams
7859 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 yes | yes | yes | yes
7862 Arguments : none
7863
7864 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7865 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7866 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7867 receive data or not.
7868
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007869 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007870 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7871 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7872 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7873 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7874 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7875 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7876 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7877 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7878 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7879 socket buffers.
7880
7881 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7882 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7883 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7884 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7885 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7886
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007887 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007888
7889
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007890option ldap-check
7891 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7893 yes | no | yes | yes
7894 Arguments : none
7895
7896 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7897 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7898 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7899 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7900
7901 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7902 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7903
7904 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7905 configure it.
7906
7907 Example :
7908 option ldap-check
7909
7910 See also : "option httpchk"
7911
7912
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007913option external-check
7914 Use external processes for server health checks
7915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7916 yes | no | yes | yes
7917
7918 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7919 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7920 command".
7921
7922 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7923
7924 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7925
7926
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007927option log-health-checks
7928no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007929 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7931 yes | no | yes | yes
7932 Arguments : none
7933
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007934 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7935 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7936 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007937
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007938 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7939 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7940 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7941 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7942 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7943
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007944 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007945 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007946
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007947 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7948 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7949 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007950
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007951
7952option log-separate-errors
7953no option log-separate-errors
7954 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 yes | yes | yes | no
7957 Arguments : none
7958
7959 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7960 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7961 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7962 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7963 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7964 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7965 provides very important information.
7966
7967 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7968 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7969 error logs.
7970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007971 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007972 logging.
7973
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007974
7975option logasap
7976no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007977 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7979 yes | yes | yes | no
7980 Arguments : none
7981
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007982 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7983 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7984 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7985 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7986
7987 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7988 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7989 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7990 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7991 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007992 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007993 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7994 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7995 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7996 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007997 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007998
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007999 Examples :
8000 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8001 mode http
8002 option httplog
8003 option logasap
8004 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8005
8006 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8007 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8008 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8009 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008011 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008012 logging.
8013
8014
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008015option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008016 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8018 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008019 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008020 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8021 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008022 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8023 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008024
8025 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8026 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008027 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008028 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8029 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8030 in the MySQL table, like this :
8031
8032 USE mysql;
8033 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8034 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8035
8036 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008037 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008038 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8039 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8040 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8041 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8042 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8043 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8044 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8045
8046 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8047 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008048
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008049 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008050
8051 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8052 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8053 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8054 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008055 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8056 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008057
8058 See also: "option httpchk"
8059
8060
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008061option nolinger
8062no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008063 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008064 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008066 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008067
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008068 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008069 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8070 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8071 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8072 connections.
8073
8074 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8075 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8076 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8077 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8078 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8079 this too.
8080
8081 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8082 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8083 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8084
8085 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8086 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8087 for servers.
8088
8089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8091
8092
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008093option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8094 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8096 yes | yes | yes | yes
8097 Arguments :
8098 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8099 matching <network>
8100 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8101 header name.
8102
8103 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8104 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8105 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8106 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8107 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8108 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8109 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8110 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8111 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8112 possible that the client has already brought one.
8113
8114 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8115 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8116 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8117 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8118 header and requires different one.
8119
8120 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8121 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8122 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8123 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8124 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8125 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8126 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8127
8128 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8129 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8130 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8131 both are defined.
8132
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008133 Examples :
8134 # Original Destination address
8135 frontend www
8136 mode http
8137 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8138
8139 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8140 backend www
8141 mode http
8142 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8143
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008144 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008145
8146
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008147option persist
8148no option persist
8149 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8150 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8151 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008152 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008153
8154 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8155 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8156 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8157 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8158 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8159 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8160 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8161 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8162 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8163 redirected to another valid server.
8164
8165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8167
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008168 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008169
8170
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008171option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8172 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8174 yes | no | yes | yes
8175 Arguments :
8176 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8177 PostgreSQL server.
8178
8179 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8180 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8181 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8182 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8183
8184 See also: "option httpchk"
8185
8186
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008187option prefer-last-server
8188no option prefer-last-server
8189 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8190 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8191 yes | no | yes | yes
8192 Arguments : none
8193
8194 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8195 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8196 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8197 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8198 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8199 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8200 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8201 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8202 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008203 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8204 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008205 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8206 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8207 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008208 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8209 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8210 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008211
8212 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8213 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8214
8215 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8216
8217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008218option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008219option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008220no option redispatch
8221 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8223 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008224 Arguments :
8225 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8226 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8227 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008228 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008229 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008230 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008231 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8232 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8233 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008235
8236 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8237 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8238 be able to access the service anymore.
8239
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008240 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8241 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008242
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008243 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8244 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8245 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8246 following order:
8247
8248 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8249
8250 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8251 list, or
8252
8253 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8254
8255 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8256 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8257
8258 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8259 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8260 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8261 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8262
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008263 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008264 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8265 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8269
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008270 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008271
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008272
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008273option redis-check
8274 Use redis health checks for server testing
8275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 yes | no | yes | yes
8277 Arguments : none
8278
8279 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8280 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8281 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8282 find the "+PONG" response message.
8283
8284 Example :
8285 option redis-check
8286
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008287 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008288
8289
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008290option smtpchk
8291option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8292 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8294 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008295 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008296 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008297 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008298 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8299
8300 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8301 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8302 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8303
8304 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8305 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8306 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8307 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8308 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8309 dead server.
8310
8311 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8312 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008313 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008314 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8315
8316 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8317 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8318 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8319 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008320 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008321
8322 Example :
8323 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8324
8325 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008328option socket-stats
8329no option socket-stats
8330
8331 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8333 yes | yes | yes | no
8334
8335 Arguments : none
8336
8337
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008338option splice-auto
8339no option splice-auto
8340 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8342 yes | yes | yes | yes
8343 Arguments : none
8344
8345 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8346 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008347 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008348 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008349 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008350 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8351 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8352 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8353 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8354
8355 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8356 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8357 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8358 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8359 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8360 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8361 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8362 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8363 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8364 keyword.
8365
8366 Example :
8367 option splice-auto
8368
8369 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8370 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8371
8372 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8373 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8374
8375
8376option splice-request
8377no option splice-request
8378 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8380 yes | yes | yes | yes
8381 Arguments : none
8382
8383 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008384 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008385 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8386 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8387 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8388 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8389
8390 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8391
8392 Example :
8393 option splice-request
8394
8395 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8396 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8397
8398 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8399 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8400
8401
8402option splice-response
8403no option splice-response
8404 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8406 yes | yes | yes | yes
8407 Arguments : none
8408
8409 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008410 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008411 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8412 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8413 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8414 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8415
8416 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8417
8418 Example :
8419 option splice-response
8420
8421 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8422 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8423
8424 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8425 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8426
8427
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008428option spop-check
8429 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8431 no | no | no | yes
8432 Arguments : none
8433
8434 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8435 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8436 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8437 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8438
8439 Example :
8440 option spop-check
8441
8442 See also : "option httpchk"
8443
8444
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008445option srvtcpka
8446no option srvtcpka
8447 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8449 yes | no | yes | yes
8450 Arguments : none
8451
8452 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8453 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008454 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008455 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8456
8457 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8458 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8459 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8460 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8461
8462 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8463 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8464 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8465 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8466 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8467
8468 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8469
8470 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8471 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8472 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8473
8474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8476
8477 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8478
8479
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008480option ssl-hello-chk
8481 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8483 yes | no | yes | yes
8484 Arguments : none
8485
8486 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8487 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8488 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8489 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8490 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8491 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8492 hello message.
8493
8494 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8495 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8496 messages, which is appreciable.
8497
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008498 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8499 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8500 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008501
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008502 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8503
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008504
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008505option tcp-check
8506 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8508 yes | no | yes | yes
8509
8510 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8511 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8512
8513 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8514 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8515 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8516
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008517 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008518 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8519 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8520 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8521 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8522 only.
8523
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008524 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008525 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8526 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8527 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8528 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8529
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008530 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008531 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8532 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008533 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008534 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8535 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8536 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8537 the respective protocols.
8538 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008539 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008540
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008541 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008542
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008543 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8544 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8545 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8546 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008547
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008548 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8549 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8550 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008551
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008552
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008553 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008554 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008555 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008556 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008557
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008558 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008559 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008560 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008561
8562 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8563 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008564 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008565 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008566 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008567 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008568 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008569 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008570 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8571 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008572 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008573 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8574 tcp-check expect string +OK
8575
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008576 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008577 (send many headers before analyzing)
8578 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008579 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008580 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8581 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8582 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8583 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008584 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008585
8586
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008587 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008588
8589
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008590option tcp-smart-accept
8591no option tcp-smart-accept
8592 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8594 yes | yes | yes | no
8595 Arguments : none
8596
8597 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8598 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8599 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8600 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8601 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8602 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8603
8604 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8605 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8606 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8607 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8608
8609 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8610 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8611 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008612 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008613
8614 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8615 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8616 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8617
8618 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8619 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8620 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8621
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008622 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8623
8624
8625option tcp-smart-connect
8626no option tcp-smart-connect
8627 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8629 yes | no | yes | yes
8630 Arguments : none
8631
8632 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8633 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8634 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8635 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8636 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8637
8638 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8639 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8640 complex.
8641
8642 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8643 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8644 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8645
8646 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8647 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8648
8649 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8650
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008651
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008652option tcpka
8653 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8655 yes | yes | yes | yes
8656 Arguments : none
8657
8658 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8659 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008660 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008661 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8662
8663 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8664 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8665 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8666 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8667
8668 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8669 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8670 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8671 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8672 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8673
8674 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8675
8676 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8677 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8678 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8679 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8680 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8681 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8682 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8683 backends.
8684
8685 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8686
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008687
8688option tcplog
8689 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008691 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008692 Arguments : none
8693
8694 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8695 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8696 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8697 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8698 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8699 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8700 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8701 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8702
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008703 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008705 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008706
8707
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008708option transparent
8709no option transparent
8710 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008712 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008713 Arguments : none
8714
8715 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8716 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8717 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8718 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8719 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8720 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8721 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8722 appropriate server.
8723
8724 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8725 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8726
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008727 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008728 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008729
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008730
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008731external-check command <command>
8732 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8734 yes | no | yes | yes
8735
8736 Arguments :
8737 <command> is the external command to run
8738
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008739 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8740
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008741 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008742
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008743 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8744 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8745 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8746 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8747 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8748 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008749
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008750 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8751
8752 Environment variables :
8753 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8754 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8755
8756 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8757
8758 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8759
8760 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8761 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8762 for a UNIX socket).
8763
8764 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8765
8766 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8767
8768 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8769
8770 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8771
8772 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8773
8774 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8775 socket).
8776
8777 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8778 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8779
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008780 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8781
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008782 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8783 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8784 failed.
8785
8786 Example :
8787 external-check command /bin/true
8788
8789 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8790
8791
8792external-check path <path>
8793 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8795 yes | no | yes | yes
8796
8797 Arguments :
8798 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8799
8800 The default path is "".
8801
8802 Example :
8803 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8804
8805 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8806 "external-check command"
8807
8808
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008809persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008810persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008811 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8813 yes | no | yes | yes
8814 Arguments :
8815 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008816 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8817 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008818
8819 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8820 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008821 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008822 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8823 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8824 forwarded to this server.
8825
8826 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8827 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8828 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008829 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008830 a single "listen" section.
8831
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008832 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8833 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8834 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8835
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008836 Example :
8837 listen tse-farm
8838 bind :3389
8839 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8840 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8841 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8842 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8843 persist rdp-cookie
8844 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008845 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008846 balance rdp-cookie
8847 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8848 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8849
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008850 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8851 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008852
8853
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008854rate-limit sessions <rate>
8855 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8857 yes | yes | yes | no
8858 Arguments :
8859 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8860 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8861
8862 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8863 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8864 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8865 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8866 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8867 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8868
8869 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8870 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8871 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8872 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8873
8874 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8875 listen smtp
8876 mode tcp
8877 bind :25
8878 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008879 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008880
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008881 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8882 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8883 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008884
8885 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8886
8887
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008888redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8889redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8890redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008891 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8893 no | yes | yes | yes
8894
8895 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008896 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008897
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008898 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008899 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008900 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8901 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8902 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008903
8904 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8905 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8906 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8907 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8908 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008909 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8910 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8911 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8912 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008913
8914 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8915 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8916 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8917 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8918 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8919 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008920 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008921 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008922 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8923 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8924 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008925
8926 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008927 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8928 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8929 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008930 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008931 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8932 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8933 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8934 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008935
8936 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008937 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008938
8939 - "drop-query"
8940 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8941 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8942 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8943 with a location-type redirect.
8944
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008945 - "append-slash"
8946 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8947 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8948 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8949 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8950
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008951 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8952 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8953 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8954 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8955 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8956 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8957 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8958
8959 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8960 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8961 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8962 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8963 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8964 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8965 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008966
8967 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8968 acl clear dst_port 80
8969 acl secure dst_port 8080
8970 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008971 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008972 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008973 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8974
8975 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008976 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8977 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8978 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008979 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008980
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008981 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8982 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8983 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8984
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008985 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008986 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008987
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008988 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008989 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8990 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8991 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008993 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008994
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008995
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008996retries <value>
8997 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8999 yes | no | yes | yes
9000 Arguments :
9001 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9002 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9003 default value is 3.
9004
9005 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9006 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9007 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9008
9009 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009010 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9011 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009012
9013 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9014 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9015
9016 See also : "option redispatch"
9017
9018
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009019retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009020 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9021 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9022 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009023 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9024 yes | no | yes | yes
9025 Arguments :
9026 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9027 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9028 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9029 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9030
9031 none never retry
9032
9033 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9034 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9035
9036 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9037 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9038 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9039 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9040 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9041 processing the request.
9042
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009043 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9044 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9045 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9046 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9047 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9048 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9049 overflow attack for example).
9050
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009051 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9052 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9053 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9054 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9055 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9056 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9057 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9058 amplify denial of service attacks.
9059
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009060 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9061 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9062 considered to be safe to retry.
9063
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009064 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9065 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9066 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9067 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9068
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009069 all-retryable-errors
9070 retry request for any error that are considered
9071 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9072 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9073 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9074
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009075 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9076 not cumulative.
9077
9078 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9079 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9080 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9081 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9082
9083 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9084 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9085 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9086 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9087 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9088 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9089 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9090 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9091 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9092 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9093 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9094 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9095
9096 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9097 should not use this directive.
9098
9099 The default is "conn-failure".
9100
9101 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9102
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009103server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009104 Declare a server in a backend
9105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9106 no | no | yes | yes
9107 Arguments :
9108 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009109 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009110 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009111
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009112 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9113 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9114 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9115 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009116 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9117 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9118 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9119 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9120 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009121 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9122 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9123 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9124 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9125 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9126 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9127 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009128 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009129 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9130 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9131 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9132 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9133 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9134 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009135 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9136 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009137 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9138 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009139
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009140 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009141 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9142 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9143 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9144 adding this value to the client's port.
9145
9146 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9147 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009148 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009149
9150 Examples :
9151 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9152 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009153 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009154 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9155 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9156 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009157
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009158 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9159 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9160 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9161 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9162 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9163
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009164 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9165 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009166
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009167server-state-file-name [<file>]
9168 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9169 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9170 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9171 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9172 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9173 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9174
9175 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9176 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9177
9178 global
9179 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9180
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009181 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009182 load-server-state-from-file
9183
9184 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9185 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009186
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009187server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9188 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9189 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9191 no | no | yes | yes
9192
9193 Arguments:
9194 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9195
9196 <num | range>
9197 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9198 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9199 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9200 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9201
9202 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9203
9204 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9205
9206 <params*>
9207 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9208 keyword.
9209
9210 Examples:
9211 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9212 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9213 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9214
9215 # or
9216 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9217
9218 # would be equivalent to:
9219 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9220 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9221 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9222
9223
9224
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009225source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009226source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009227source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009228 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9230 yes | no | yes | yes
9231 Arguments :
9232 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9233 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009234
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009235 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009236 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9237 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9238 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9239 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9240 supported prefixes are :
9241 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9242 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9243 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009244 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009245 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9246 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009247
9248 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9249 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009250 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9251 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9252 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009253
9254 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9255 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9256 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9257 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9258 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9259 <addr>.
9260
9261 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9262 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9263 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9264 port.
9265
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009266 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9267 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9268 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9269 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009270 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009271 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9272 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9273 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9274 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9275 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9276 HTTP header.
9277
9278 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9279 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009280 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009281 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9282 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9283 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9284 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9285 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9286 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9287 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9288
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009289 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9290 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9291 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9292 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9293 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9294 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9295
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009296 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9297 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9298 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9299 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9300
9301 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9302 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9303 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9304 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9305 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9306 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9307
9308 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9309 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9310 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9311 there are two methods :
9312
9313 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9314 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9315 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9316 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9317 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9318 of the client ranges may be used.
9319
9320 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9321 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9322 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9323 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9324 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9325 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9326 same session.
9327
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009328 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9329 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9330 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009331 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009332
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009333 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9334
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009335 Examples :
9336 backend private
9337 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9338 source 192.168.1.200
9339
9340 backend transparent_ssl1
9341 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9342 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9343
9344 backend transparent_ssl2
9345 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9346 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9347 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9348
9349 backend transparent_ssl3
9350 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9351 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9352 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9353
9354 backend transparent_smtp
9355 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9356 # with Tproxy version 4.
9357 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9358
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009359 backend transparent_http
9360 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9361 # proxy.
9362 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009364 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009365 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9366
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009367
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009368stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9369 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009371 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009372
9373 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9374 matched.
9375
9376 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9377 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9378
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009379 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9380 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009381 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009382
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009383 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9384 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9385 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9386 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009387
9388 Example :
9389 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9390 backend stats_localhost
9391 stats enable
9392 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9393
9394 Example :
9395 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9396 backend stats_auth
9397 stats enable
9398 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9399 stats admin if TRUE
9400
9401 Example :
9402 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9403 userlist stats-auth
9404 group admin users admin
9405 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9406 group readonly users haproxy
9407 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9408
9409 backend stats_auth
9410 stats enable
9411 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9412 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9413 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9414 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9415
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009416 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9417 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9418 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009419
9420
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009421stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9422 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009424 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009425 Arguments :
9426 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9427
9428 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9429
9430 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9431 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9432 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9433 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9434 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9435 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9436
9437 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9438 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9439 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009440 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009441
9442 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9443 report using "stats scope".
9444
9445 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9446 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9447 unobvious parameters.
9448
9449 Example :
9450 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9451 backend public_www
9452 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9453 stats enable
9454 stats hide-version
9455 stats scope .
9456 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009457 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009458 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9459 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9460
9461 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9462 backend private_monitoring
9463 stats enable
9464 stats uri /admin?stats
9465 stats refresh 5s
9466
9467 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9468
9469
9470stats enable
9471 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009473 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009474 Arguments : none
9475
9476 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9477 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9478 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9479 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9480 - stats auth : no authentication
9481 - stats scope : no restriction
9482
9483 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9484 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9485 unobvious parameters.
9486
9487 Example :
9488 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9489 backend public_www
9490 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9491 stats enable
9492 stats hide-version
9493 stats scope .
9494 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009495 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009496 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9497 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9498
9499 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9500 backend private_monitoring
9501 stats enable
9502 stats uri /admin?stats
9503 stats refresh 5s
9504
9505 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9506
9507
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009508stats hide-version
9509 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009511 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009512 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009513
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009514 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9515 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9516 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9517 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9518 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9519 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009521 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9522 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9523 unobvious parameters.
9524
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009525 Example :
9526 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9527 backend public_www
9528 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009529 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009530 stats hide-version
9531 stats scope .
9532 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009533 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009534 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9535 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009536
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009537 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9538 backend private_monitoring
9539 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009540 stats uri /admin?stats
9541 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009542
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009543 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009544
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009545
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009546stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9547 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9548 Access control for statistics
9549
9550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9551 no | no | yes | yes
9552
9553 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9554 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9555 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9556 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9557 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9558 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9559
9560 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9561 instance.
9562
9563 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9564 about ACL usage.
9565
9566
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009567stats realm <realm>
9568 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009570 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009571 Arguments :
9572 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9573 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9574 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9575
9576 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9577 using a backslash ('\').
9578
9579 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9580 only related to authentication.
9581
9582 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9583 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9584 unobvious parameters.
9585
9586 Example :
9587 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9588 backend public_www
9589 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9590 stats enable
9591 stats hide-version
9592 stats scope .
9593 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009594 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009595 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9596 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9597
9598 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9599 backend private_monitoring
9600 stats enable
9601 stats uri /admin?stats
9602 stats refresh 5s
9603
9604 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9605
9606
9607stats refresh <delay>
9608 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009610 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009611 Arguments :
9612 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9613 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9614 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9615 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9616 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9617 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9618
9619 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9620 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9621 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9622 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9623
9624 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9625 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9626 unobvious parameters.
9627
9628 Example :
9629 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9630 backend public_www
9631 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9632 stats enable
9633 stats hide-version
9634 stats scope .
9635 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009636 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009637 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9638 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9639
9640 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9641 backend private_monitoring
9642 stats enable
9643 stats uri /admin?stats
9644 stats refresh 5s
9645
9646 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9647
9648
9649stats scope { <name> | "." }
9650 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009652 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009653 Arguments :
9654 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9655 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9656 section in which the statement appears.
9657
9658 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9659 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9660 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9661 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9662 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9663 exists.
9664
9665 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9666 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9667 unobvious parameters.
9668
9669 Example :
9670 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9671 backend public_www
9672 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9673 stats enable
9674 stats hide-version
9675 stats scope .
9676 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009678 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9679 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9680
9681 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9682 backend private_monitoring
9683 stats enable
9684 stats uri /admin?stats
9685 stats refresh 5s
9686
9687 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9688
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009689
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009690stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009691 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009693 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009694
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009695 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009696 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9697
9698 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9699 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9700
9701 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9702 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009703 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009704
9705 Example :
9706 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9707 backend private_monitoring
9708 stats enable
9709 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9710 stats uri /admin?stats
9711 stats refresh 5s
9712
9713 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9714 global section.
9715
9716
9717stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009718 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9720 yes | yes | yes | yes
9721 Arguments : none
9722
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009723 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009724 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9725 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9726 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9727 - IP (socket, server)
9728 - cookie (backend, server)
9729
9730 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9731 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009732 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009733
9734 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9735
9736
9737stats show-node [ <name> ]
9738 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009740 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009741 Arguments:
9742 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9743 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9744
9745 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9746 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009747 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009748
9749 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9750 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9751 unobvious parameters.
9752
9753 Example:
9754 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9755 backend private_monitoring
9756 stats enable
9757 stats show-node Europe-1
9758 stats uri /admin?stats
9759 stats refresh 5s
9760
9761 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9762 section.
9763
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009764
9765stats uri <prefix>
9766 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009768 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009769 Arguments :
9770 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9771 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9772 query string.
9773
9774 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9775 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9776 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9777 possible to reach it in the application.
9778
9779 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009780 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009781 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9782 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9783 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9784 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9785
9786 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9787 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9788 an address or a port to statistics only.
9789
9790 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9791 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9792 unobvious parameters.
9793
9794 Example :
9795 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9796 backend public_www
9797 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9798 stats enable
9799 stats hide-version
9800 stats scope .
9801 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009802 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009803 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9804 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9805
9806 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9807 backend private_monitoring
9808 stats enable
9809 stats uri /admin?stats
9810 stats refresh 5s
9811
9812 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9813
9814
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009815stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9816 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009818 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009819
9820 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009821 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009822 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009823 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009824 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9825
9826 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9827 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9828 the "stick-table" statement.
9829
9830 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9831 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9832 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9833 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9834 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9835
9836 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9837 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9838 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9839 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9840 transformation rules.
9841
9842 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9843 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9844 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9845 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9846 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9847 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9848 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9849
9850 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9851 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9852 ACL based conditions.
9853
9854 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9855 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9856 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9857 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9858
9859 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9860 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9861 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9862 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9863
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009864 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9865 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009866 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009867
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009868 Example :
9869 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9870 # last 30 minutes
9871 backend pop
9872 mode tcp
9873 balance roundrobin
9874 stick store-request src
9875 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9876 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9877 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9878
9879 backend smtp
9880 mode tcp
9881 balance roundrobin
9882 stick match src table pop
9883 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9884 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9885
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009886 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009887 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009888
9889
9890stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9891 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9893 no | no | yes | yes
9894
9895 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9896 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9897 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9898 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9899
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009900 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9901 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009902 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009903
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009904 Examples :
9905 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009906 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009907
9908 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9909 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9910 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9911
9912
9913 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9914 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9915 backend http
9916 mode http
9917 balance roundrobin
9918 stick on src table https
9919 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9920 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9921 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9922
9923 backend https
9924 mode tcp
9925 balance roundrobin
9926 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9927 stick on src
9928 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9929 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9930
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009931 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009932
9933
9934stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9935 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9937 no | no | yes | yes
9938
9939 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009940 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009941 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009942 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009943 server is selected.
9944
9945 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9946 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9947 the "stick-table" statement.
9948
9949 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9950 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9951 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9952 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9953 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9954 address.
9955
9956 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9957 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9958 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9959 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9960 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9961 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9962 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9963 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9964 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9965 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9966
9967 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9968 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9969 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9970 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9971 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9972 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9973 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9974
9975 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9976 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9977 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9978 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9979
9980 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9981 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9982 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9983 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9984 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9985 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009986 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9987 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9988 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9989 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9990 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9991 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009992
9993 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9994 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9995 the request.
9996
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009997 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9998 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009999 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010000
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010001 Example :
10002 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10003 # last 30 minutes
10004 backend pop
10005 mode tcp
10006 balance roundrobin
10007 stick store-request src
10008 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10009 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10010 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10011
10012 backend smtp
10013 mode tcp
10014 balance roundrobin
10015 stick match src table pop
10016 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10017 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10018
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010019 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010020 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010021
10022
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010023stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010024 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10025 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010026 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010028 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010029
10030 Arguments :
10031 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10032 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10033 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10034 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10035
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010036 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10037 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10038 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10039 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10040
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010041 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10042 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10043 instance.
10044
10045 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10046 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10047 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10048 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10049 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10050 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010051 to 32 characters.
10052
10053 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10054 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10055 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010056 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010057 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10058 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010059
10060 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010061 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10062 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010063 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10064 increase.
10065
10066 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010067 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10068 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10069 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010070
10071 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10072 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10073 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10074 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010075 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010076 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10077 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10078 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10079 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10080 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10081 parameter (see below).
10082
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010083 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10084 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10085 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10086 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10087 soft restart.
10088
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010089 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10090 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010091
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010092 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10093 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10094 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10095 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010096 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010097 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010098 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10099 if not expiration delay is specified.
10100
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010101 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10102 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10103 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10104 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010105 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10106 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10107 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10108 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10109 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10110 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10111 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10112 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10113 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10114 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10115 types and their arguments.
10116
10117 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10118 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10119 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10120 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10121
10122 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10123 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10124 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010125 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010126
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010127 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10128 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10129 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010130 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010131 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010132 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010133
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010134 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10135 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10136 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10137 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10138
10139 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10140 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10141 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10142 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10143 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10144 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10145
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010146 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10147 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10148 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10149 they were received.
10150
10151 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10152 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10153 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10154 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10155 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10156
10157 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10158 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10159 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10160 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10161 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10162
10163 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10164 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10165 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10166
10167 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10168 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10169 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10170 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10171 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10172
10173 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10174 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10175 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10176 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10177 the client side.
10178
10179 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10180 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10181 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10182 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10183 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10184 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10185 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10186
10187 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10188 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10189 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10190 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10191 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10192 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010193 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010194
10195 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10196 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10197 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10198 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10199 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10200 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10201
10202 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010203 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010204 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10205 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10206
10207 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10208 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10209 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10210 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10211 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10212 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10213 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10214 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10215 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10216 recommended for better fairness.
10217
10218 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010219 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010220 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10221 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10222
10223 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10224 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10225 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10226 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10227 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10228 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10229 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10230 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10231 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10232 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010233
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010234 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10235 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010236 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10237 reference it.
10238
10239 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10240 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010241 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10242 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10243 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010244
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010245 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10246 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10247 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10248 something that can be ignored.
10249
10250 Example:
10251 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10252 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10253 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10254 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10255
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010256 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010257 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010258
10259
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010260stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010261 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10263 no | no | yes | yes
10264
10265 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010266 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010267 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010268 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010269 server is selected.
10270
10271 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10272 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10273 the "stick-table" statement.
10274
10275 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10276 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10277 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10278 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10279
10280 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10281 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10282 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10283 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10284 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10285 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010286 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010287 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10288 rules.
10289
10290 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10291 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10292 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10293 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10294 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10295 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10296 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10297
10298 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10299 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10300 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10301 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10302
10303 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10304 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10305 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10306 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10307 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10308 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010309 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10310 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10311 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10312 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10313 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10314 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10315 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10316 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10317 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010318
10319 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10320
10321 Example :
10322 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10323 backend https
10324 mode tcp
10325 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010326 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010327 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010328
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010329 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10330 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10331
10332 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10333 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10334 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10335
10336 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10337 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010338
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010339 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10340 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10341 # at offset 44.
10342
10343 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10344 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10345
10346 # Learn on response if server hello.
10347 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010348
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010349 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10350 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10351
10352 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10353 extraction.
10354
10355
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010356tcp-check comment <string>
10357 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10358 it fails.
10359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10360 yes | no | yes | yes
10361
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010362 Arguments :
10363 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10364 rule fails.
10365
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010366 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10367 user-friendly error reporting.
10368
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010369 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10370 "tcp-check expect".
10371
10372
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010373tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10374 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010375 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010376 Opens a new connection
10377 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010378 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010379
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010380 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010381 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10382
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010383 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010384 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010385
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010386 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010387 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10388 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010389 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010390
10391 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010392
10393 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10394
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010395 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10396
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010397 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10398
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010399 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10400
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010401 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10402 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10403 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10404 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10405
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010406 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10407 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10408 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10409 haproxy -vv.
10410
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010411 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010412
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010413 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10414 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10415 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10416
10417 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10418 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10419 of the sequence.
10420
10421 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10422 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10423 do.
10424
10425 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10426 unset-var or comment rules.
10427
10428 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010429 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10430 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10431 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10432 option tcp-check
10433 tcp-check connect
10434 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10435 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10436 tcp-check send \r\n
10437 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10438 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10439 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10440 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10441 tcp-check send \r\n
10442 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10443 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10444
10445 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10446 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010447 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010448 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10449 tcp-check connect port 143
10450 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10451 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10452
10453 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10454
10455
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010456tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010457 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010458 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010459 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010460 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010462 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010463
10464 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010465 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10466
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010467 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10468 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10469 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10470 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10471 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10472 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10473 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10474 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10475 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10476 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10477
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010478 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010479 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10480 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010481 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10482 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10483 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10484
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010485 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10486 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10487 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010488 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10489 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10490 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10491 example 404 with disable-on-404
10492 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10493 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010494 By default "L7OK" is used.
10495
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010496 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10497 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010498 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10499 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10500 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10501 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10502 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10503 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010504
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010505 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010506 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010507 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10508 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10509 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10510 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010511 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10512
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010513 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10514 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10515 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10516 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10517
10518 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10519 informational message reported in logs if an error
10520 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10521 log-format string.
10522
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010523 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10524 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10525 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10526 followed by some converters.
10527
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010528 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10529 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10530 with the usual backslash ('\').
10531 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010532 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010533 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10534 used upper or lower case.
10535
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010536 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10537
10538 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10539 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10540 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10541 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10542 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10543 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10544 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10545 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10546
10547 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10548 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10549 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10550 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10551 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10552 expression.
10553
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010554 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10555 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10556 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10557 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10558 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10559 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10560
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010561 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10562 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10563 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10564 this exact hexadecimal string.
10565 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10566
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010567 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10568 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10569 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10570 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10571 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10572 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10573 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10574 size.
10575
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010576 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10577 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10578 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10579 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10580 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10581 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10582 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10583 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10584 in a binary string before matching the response's
10585 buffer.
10586
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010587 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10588 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10589 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10590 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10591 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10592 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10593 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10594 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10595 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10596 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10597 the null character.
10598
10599 Examples :
10600 # perform a POP check
10601 option tcp-check
10602 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10603
10604 # perform an IMAP check
10605 option tcp-check
10606 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10607
10608 # look for the redis master server
10609 option tcp-check
10610 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010611 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010612 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10613 tcp-check expect string role:master
10614 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10615 tcp-check expect string +OK
10616
10617
10618 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10619 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10620
10621
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010622tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10623tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10624 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10625 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010627 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010628
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010629 Arguments :
10630 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10631
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010632 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10633 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010634
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010635 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10636 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010637
10638 Examples :
10639 # look for the redis master server
10640 option tcp-check
10641 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10642 tcp-check expect string role:master
10643
10644 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10645 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10646
10647
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010648tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10649tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10650 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10651 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010652 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010653 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010654
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010655 Arguments :
10656 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010657
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010658 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10659 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010660
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010661 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10662 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10663 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010664
10665 Examples :
10666 # redis check in binary
10667 option tcp-check
10668 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10669 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10670
10671
10672 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10673 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10674
10675
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010676tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010677 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010679 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010680
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010681 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010682 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10683 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10684 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10685 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10686 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10687 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10688 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10689 and '-'.
10690
10691 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10692
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010693 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010694 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10695
10696
10697tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010698 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010699 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010700 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010701
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010702 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010703 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10704 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10705 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10706 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10707 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10708 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10709 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10710 and '-'.
10711
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010712 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010713 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10714
10715
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010716tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10717 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10719 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010720 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010721 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10722 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010724 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010725
10726 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10727 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010728 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10729 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10730 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10731 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10732 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10733 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010734
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010735 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10736 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10737 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10738 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010739
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010740 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010741 - accept :
10742 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10743 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10744 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010745
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010746 - reject :
10747 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10748 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10749 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10750 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10751 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10752 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10753 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10754 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10755 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10756 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10757 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010758 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010759
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010760 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10761 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10762 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10763 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10764 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10765 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10766 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10767 hosts.
10768
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010769 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10770 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10771 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10772 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10773 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10774 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10775 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10776 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10777
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010778 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10779 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10780 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10781 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10782 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10783 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10784 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10785 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10786 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010787 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10788 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010789
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010790 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010791 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010792 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10793 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10794 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010795 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010796 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10797 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10798 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10799 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10800 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10801 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10802 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10803 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010804
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010805 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010806 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010807 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010808 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010809 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10810 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10811 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010812
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010813 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10814 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10815 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10816 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010817
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010818 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10819 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10820 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10821 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10822 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010823 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10824 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10825 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10826 layer7 information is extracted.
10827
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010828 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10829 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10830 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10831 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10832 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010833
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010834 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10835 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10836 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10837 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10838
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010839 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10840 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10841 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10842 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10843
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010844 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10845 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10846 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10847 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10848 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010849
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010850 - set-src <expr> :
10851 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10852 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10853 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010854 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010856 Arguments:
10857 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10858 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010859
10860 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010861 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10862
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010863 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10864 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010865
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010866 - set-src-port <expr> :
10867 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10868 expression.
10869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010870 Arguments:
10871 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10872 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010873
10874 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010875 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10876
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010877 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10878 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10879 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010880
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010881 - set-dst <expr> :
10882 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10883 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10884 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10885 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10886 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10887
10888 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10889 followed by some converters.
10890
10891 Example:
10892
10893 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10894 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10895
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010896 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10897 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10898
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010899 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10900 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10901 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10902 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10903
10904
10905 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10906 followed by some converters.
10907
10908 Example:
10909
10910 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10911
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010912 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10913 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10914 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10915
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010916 - "silent-drop" :
10917 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010918 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010919 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10920 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10921 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10922 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10923 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010924 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10925 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010926 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10927 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010928 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010929 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10930 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10931 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10932 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10933
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010934 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10935 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10936 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010938 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10939 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10940 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010942 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010943 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010944 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010946 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10947 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10948 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010949
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010950 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010951 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10952 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010953
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010954 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10955
10956 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10957
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010958 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10959
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010960 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010961
10962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010963tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10964 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010966 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010967 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010968 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10969 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010970
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010971 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010972
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010973 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010974 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10975 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10976 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10977 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010978
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010979 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10980 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10981 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10982 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010983 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10984 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10985 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10986 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10987 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10988 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010989 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010990 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010991
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010992 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10993 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10994 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10995 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010996
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010997 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010998 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010999 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011000 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11001 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011002 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011003 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011004 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011005 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011006 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011007 - set-dst <expr>
11008 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011009 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011010 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011011 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011012 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011013 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011015 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11016 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011017 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11018 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011019
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011020 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11021 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11022 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11023 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11024 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11025 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011027 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011028 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11029 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011031 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011032 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11033 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11034 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11035 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011036 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11037 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11038 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011039
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011040 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011041 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11042 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11043 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011044
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011045 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11046 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11047
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011048 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011049 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11050 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011051
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011052 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11053 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011054 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011055 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11056 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011057 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011058 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011059 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011060 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11061 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011062 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011063 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11064 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011065
11066 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11067 followed by some converters.
11068
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011069 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11070 <var-name>.
11071
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011072 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11073 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11074 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11075 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11076 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11077
11078 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11079 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11080 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11081 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11082 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11083 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11084 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11085 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11086 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11087 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11088 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11089
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011090 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11091 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11092 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11093 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11094 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11095
11096 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11097
11098 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11099
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011100 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11101 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11102 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11103 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11104 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11105 evaluated.
11106
11107 Example:
11108 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11109
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011110 Example:
11111
11112 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011113 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011114
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011115 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011116 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11117 # and reject everything else.
11118 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11119 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011120 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011121 tcp-request content reject
11122
11123 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011124 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11125 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11126 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011127 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011128
11129 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11130 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11131 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011132 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011133 tcp-request content reject
11134
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011135 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011136 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011137 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011138 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011139 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11140 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011141
11142 Example:
11143 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11144 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011145 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011147 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011148 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011149
11150 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011151 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011152 # protecting all our sites
11153 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011154 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11155 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011156 ...
11157 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11158
11159 backend http_dynamic
11160 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011161 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011162 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011163 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011164 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011165 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011166 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011168 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011169
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011170 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11171 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011172
11173
11174tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11175 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011177 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011178 Arguments :
11179 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11180 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11181 as explained at the top of this document.
11182
11183 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11184 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11185 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11186 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11187 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11188
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011189 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11190 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11191 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11192 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11193
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011194 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11195 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011196 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011197 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011198 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11199 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11200 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11201 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011202
11203 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11204 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11205 it pass through unaffected.
11206
11207 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11208 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11209 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011210 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011211 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11212 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011213 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11214 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11215 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011216
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011217 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011218 "timeout client".
11219
11220
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011221tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11222 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11224 no | no | yes | yes
11225 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011226 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11227 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011228
11229 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11230
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011231 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011232 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11233 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011234 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11235 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011236
11237 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11238
11239 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11240 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11241 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11242 inserted.
11243
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011244 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011245 - accept :
11246 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11247 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11248 the rules evaluation.
11249
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011250 - close :
11251 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11252 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11253 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11254 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11255 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11256 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011257 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011258 protocols.
11259
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011260 - reject :
11261 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11262 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011263 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011264
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011265 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11266 Sets a variable.
11267
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011268 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11269 Unsets a variable.
11270
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011271 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11272 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11273 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11274 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11275
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011276 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11277 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11278 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11279 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11280
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011281 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11282 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11283 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11284 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11285 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011286
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011287 - "silent-drop" :
11288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011289 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011290 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11291 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11292 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11293 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11294 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011295 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11296 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011297 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11298 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011299 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011300 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11301 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11302 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11303 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11304
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011305 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11306 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11307
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011308 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11309 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11310 for changing the default action to a reject.
11311
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011312 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11313 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11314 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11315 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011316 period.
11317
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011318 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11319 declared inline.
11320
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011321 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11322 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011323 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011324 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11325 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011326 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011327 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011328 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011329 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11330 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011331 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011332 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11333 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011334
11335 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11336 followed by some converters.
11337
11338 Example:
11339
11340 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11341
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011342 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11343 <var-name>.
11344
11345 Example:
11346
11347 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11348
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011349 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11350 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11351 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11352 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11353 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11354
11355 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11356
11357 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11358
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011359 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11360
11361 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11362
11363
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011364tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11365 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11367 no | yes | yes | no
11368 Arguments :
11369 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11370 below.
11371
11372 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011374 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011375 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11376 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11377 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11378 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11379 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11380 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11381 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011382 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011383 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11384 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11385 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11386 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11387 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11388 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11389 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11390 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11391 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11392 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11393 instead.
11394
11395 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11396 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11397 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11398 rules which may be inserted.
11399
11400 Several types of actions are supported :
11401 - accept : the request is accepted
11402 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11403 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11404 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011405 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011406 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011407 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011408 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011409 - silent-drop
11410
11411 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11412 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11413 sections for a complete description.
11414
11415 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11416 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11417 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11418
11419 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11420 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11421 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11422 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11423 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11424
11425 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11426 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11427
11428 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11429 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11430 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11431
11432 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11433 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11434 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11435
11436 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11437 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11438 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11439
11440 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11441 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11442 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11443
11444 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11445
11446 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11447
11448
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011449tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11450 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11452 no | no | yes | yes
11453 Arguments :
11454 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11455 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11456 as explained at the top of this document.
11457
11458 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11459
11460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011461timeout check <timeout>
11462 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11463 established.
11464
11465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11466 yes | no | yes | yes
11467 Arguments:
11468 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11469 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11470 as explained at the top of this document.
11471
11472 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11473 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011474 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011475 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011476 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11477 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11478 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011479
11480 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11481 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11482
11483 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11484 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011485 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011486
11487 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11488 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11489 forget about it.
11490
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011491 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11492 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011493
11494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011495timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011496 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11498 yes | yes | yes | no
11499 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011500 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011501 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11502 as explained at the top of this document.
11503
11504 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11505 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11506 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011507 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11508 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11509 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11510 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011511 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11512 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11513 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011514 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011515 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011516 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11517 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011518 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11519 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011520
11521 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11522 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11523 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11524 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011525 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011526 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11527
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011528 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011529
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011530 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011532
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011533timeout client-fin <timeout>
11534 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11536 yes | yes | yes | no
11537 Arguments :
11538 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11539 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11540 as explained at the top of this document.
11541
11542 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11543 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11544 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11545 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11546 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11547 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11548 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011549 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11550 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11551 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011552
11553 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11554 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11555 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11556
11557 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11558
11559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011560timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011561 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11563 yes | no | yes | yes
11564 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011565 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011566 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11567 as explained at the top of this document.
11568
11569 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011570 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011571 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011572 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011573 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11574 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011575
11576 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11577 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11578 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11579 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011580 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011581 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11582
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011583 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011585
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011586timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11587 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11589 yes | yes | yes | yes
11590 Arguments :
11591 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11592 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11593 as explained at the top of this document.
11594
11595 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11596 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11597 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11598 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11599 once the request has started to present itself.
11600
11601 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11602 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11603 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11604 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11605 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11606
11607 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11608 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11609 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11610 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11611
11612 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11613 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011614 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011615 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11616 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011617 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011618
11619 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11620 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11621 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11622 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11623
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011624 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11625 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011626 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11627
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011628 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11629
11630
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011631timeout http-request <timeout>
11632 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011634 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011635 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011636 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011637 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11638 as explained at the top of this document.
11639
11640 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11641 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11642 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11643 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11644 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11645 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11646 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011647 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11648 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11649 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11650 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011651 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011652 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11653 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011654
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011655 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11656 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11657 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11658 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11659 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011660 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011661
11662 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11663 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011664 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011665 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11666 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11667
11668 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011669 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11670 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11671 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011672
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011673 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011674 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011675
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011676
11677timeout queue <timeout>
11678 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11680 yes | no | yes | yes
11681 Arguments :
11682 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11683 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11684 as explained at the top of this document.
11685
11686 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11687 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11688 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11689 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11690 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11691
11692 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11693 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11694 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11695 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11696
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011697 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011698
11699
11700timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011701 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11703 yes | no | yes | yes
11704 Arguments :
11705 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11707 as explained at the top of this document.
11708
11709 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11710 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11711 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11712 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11713 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11714 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11715 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11716
11717 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11718 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11719 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11720 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11721 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011722 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011723 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011724 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11725 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011726 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11727 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011728
11729 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11730 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11731 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11732 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011733 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011734 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11735
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011736 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011737
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011738
11739timeout server-fin <timeout>
11740 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11742 yes | no | yes | yes
11743 Arguments :
11744 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11745 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11746 as explained at the top of this document.
11747
11748 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11749 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11750 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11751 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11752 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11753 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11754 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11755 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11756 situations, it should not be needed.
11757
11758 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11759 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11760 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11761
11762 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11763
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011764
11765timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011766 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11768 yes | yes | yes | yes
11769 Arguments :
11770 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11771 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11772 as explained at the top of this document.
11773
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011774 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11775 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11776 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011777
11778 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11779 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11780 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11781 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011782 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011783
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011784 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011785
11786
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011787timeout tunnel <timeout>
11788 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11790 yes | no | yes | yes
11791 Arguments :
11792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11794 as explained at the top of this document.
11795
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011796 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011797 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11798 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11799 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011800 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11801 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011802 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11803 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11804 specified.
11805
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011806 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11807 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11808 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11809 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11810 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11811 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11812 state.
11813
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011814 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11815 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11816 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11817 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011818 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011819
11820 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11821 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11822 forget about it.
11823
11824 Example :
11825 defaults http
11826 option http-server-close
11827 timeout connect 5s
11828 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011829 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011830 timeout server 30s
11831 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11832
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011833 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011834
11835
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011836transparent (deprecated)
11837 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011839 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011840 Arguments : none
11841
11842 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11843 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11844 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11845 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11846 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11847 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11848 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11849 appropriate server.
11850
11851 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11852
11853 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11854 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11855
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011856 See also: "option transparent"
11857
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011858unique-id-format <string>
11859 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11861 yes | yes | yes | no
11862 Arguments :
11863 <string> is a log-format string.
11864
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011865 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11866 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11867 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11868 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011869
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011870 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11871 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11872 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11873 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11874 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11875 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11876 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11877 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011878
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011879 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11880 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011881
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011882 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011883
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011884 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011885
11886 will generate:
11887
11888 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11889
11890 See also: "unique-id-header"
11891
11892unique-id-header <name>
11893 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11895 yes | yes | yes | no
11896 Arguments :
11897 <name> is the name of the header.
11898
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011899 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11900 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011901
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011902 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011903
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011904 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011905 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11906
11907 will generate:
11908
11909 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11910
11911 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011912
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011913use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011914 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11916 no | yes | yes | no
11917 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011918 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11919 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011920
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011921 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11922 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011923
11924 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11925 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11926 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011927 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011928 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011929 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11930 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011931
11932 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11933 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11934 assign the backend.
11935
11936 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11937 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11938 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11939 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11940 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11941 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11942
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011943 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011944 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011945 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11946 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11947 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11948
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011949 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11950 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11951 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11952 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11953 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11954 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11955 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11956 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11957 cannot be forced from the request.
11958
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011959 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011960 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11961 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11962
11963 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11964 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011965
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011966use-fcgi-app <name>
11967 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11969 no | no | yes | yes
11970 Arguments :
11971 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11972
11973 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011974
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011975use-server <server> if <condition>
11976use-server <server> unless <condition>
11977 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11979 no | no | yes | yes
11980 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011981 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11982 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011983
11984 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11985
11986 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11987 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11988 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11989
11990 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11991 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11992 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11993 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11994 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11995 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11996 matches will assign the server.
11997
11998 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11999 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12000 with the next rules until one matches.
12001
12002 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12003 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12004 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12005 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12006
12007 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12008 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12009 stripped.
12010
12011 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12012 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
12013 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
12014 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
12015
12016 Example :
12017 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12018 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12019 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12020 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
12021 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
12022 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012023 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012024 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12025 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12026
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012027 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12028 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12029 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12030 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012031 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012032 and we fall back to load balancing.
12033
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012034 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012035
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012036
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120375. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012038--------------------------
12039
12040The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12041depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12042settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12043written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12044described in this section.
12045
12046
120475.1. Bind options
12048-----------------
12049
12050The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12051as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12052no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12053parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12054while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12055provided immediately after the setting name.
12056
12057The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12058
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012059accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12060 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12061 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12062 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12063 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12064 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12065 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12066 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12067 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12068 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012069 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12070 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12071 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012072
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012073accept-proxy
12074 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012075 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12076 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012077 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12078 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12079 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12080 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012081 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012082 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12083 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012084 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12085 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012086
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012087allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012088 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012089 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012090 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012091 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12092 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012093
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012094alpn <protocols>
12095 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12096 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12097 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012098 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012099 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012100 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12101 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12102 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12103 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12104 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12105 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12106 preference, like below :
12107
12108 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012110backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012111 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012112 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12113
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012114curves <curves>
12115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12116 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12117 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12118 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12119 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12120 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12121
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012122ecdhe <named curve>
12123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012124 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12125 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012126
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012127ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12129 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12130 client's certificate.
12131
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012132ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12134 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12135 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12136 error is ignored.
12137
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012138ca-sign-file <cafile>
12139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12140 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12141 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12142 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12143 'generate-certificates' for details.
12144
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012145ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12147 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12148 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12149 'generate-certificates' for details.
12150
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012151ca-verify-file <cafile>
12152 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12153 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12154 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12155 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12156 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12157
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012158ciphers <ciphers>
12159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12160 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012161 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012162 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012163 information and recommendations see e.g.
12164 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12165 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12166 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12167
12168ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12170 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12171 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12172 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012173 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12174 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012175
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012176crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12178 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12179 to verify client's certificate.
12180
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012181crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12183 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12184 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12185 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12186 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012187 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12188 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012189
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012190 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12191 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12192
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012193 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12194 are loaded.
12195
12196 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012197 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12198 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12199 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12200 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12201 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12202 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12203 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012204 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012205
12206 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12207 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12208 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12209 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012210 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12211 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012212
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012213 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012214
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012215 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012216 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012217 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12218 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012219 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12220 clients).
12221
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012222 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12223 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12224 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12225 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12226 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12227 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12228 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12229 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12230 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12231 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12232 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12233 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12234 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12235
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012236 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12237 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12238 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12239 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12240 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12241
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012242 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12243 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12244 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12245 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012246
12247 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12248 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12249 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12250 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12251 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12252 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12253 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12254 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12255 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12256
12257 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12258
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012259 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012260 a cert bundle.
12261
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012262 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012263 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12264 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12265 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12266 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12267 provide multi-cert support.
12268
12269 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12270
12271 Filename | CN | SAN
12272 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12273 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012274 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012275 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12276 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12277
12278 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12279 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12280 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12281 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012282 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12283 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12284 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012285
12286 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12287 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12288
12289 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12290 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12291 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12292
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012293crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012295 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012296 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012297 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012298
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012299crt-list <file>
12300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012301 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12302 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012303
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012304 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12305
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012306 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12307 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12308 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12309 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12310 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012311
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012312 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12313 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12314 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12315 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12316 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12317 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12318 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12319 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012320
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012321 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012322 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012323 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12324 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12325 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012326
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012327 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12328
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012329 crt-list file example:
12330 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012331 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012332 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012333 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012334 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012335
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012336defer-accept
12337 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12338 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12339 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012340 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012341 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12342 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12343 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12344 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12345 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12346 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12347 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12348
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012349expose-fd listeners
12350 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12351 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012352 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12353 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012354 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012355
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012356force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012357 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012358 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012359 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012360 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012361
12362force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012363 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012364 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012365 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012366
12367force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012368 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012369 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012370 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012371
12372force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012373 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012374 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012375 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012376
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012377force-tlsv13
12378 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12379 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012380 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012381
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012382generate-certificates
12383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12384 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12385 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12386 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12387 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12388 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12389 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12390 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12391 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12392 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12393 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12394
12395 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12396 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012397 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012398 certificate is used many times.
12399
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012400gid <gid>
12401 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12402 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12403 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12404 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12405 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12406
12407group <group>
12408 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12409 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12410 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12411 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12412 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12413
12414id <id>
12415 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12416 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12417 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12418 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12419
12420interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012421 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12422 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12423 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12424 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12425 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12426 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012427 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12428 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12429 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12430 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12431 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12432 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012433
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012434level <level>
12435 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12436 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12437 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012438 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012439 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12440 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12441 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012442 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012443 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012444 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012445 all counters).
12446
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012447severity-output <format>
12448 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12449 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12450 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12451 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12452 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12453 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12454 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12455 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12456 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12457 rfc5424 convention.
12458
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012459maxconn <maxconn>
12460 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12461 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12462 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12463 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12464 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12465 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12466 eat all memory.
12467
12468mode <mode>
12469 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12470 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12471 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12472 UNIX sockets.
12473
12474mss <maxseg>
12475 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12476 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12477 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12478 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12479 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12480 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12481 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12482 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12483 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12484 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12485 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12486
12487name <name>
12488 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12489 page.
12490
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012491namespace <name>
12492 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12493 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12494 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12495 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12496
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012497nice <nice>
12498 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12499 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12500 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12501 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12502 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12503 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12504 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12505 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12506 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12507 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12508 one for an RDP socket.
12509
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012510no-ca-names
12511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12512 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012513 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012514
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012515no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012517 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012518 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012519 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012520 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12521 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012522
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012523no-tls-tickets
12524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12525 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12526 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012527 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12528 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012529 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12530 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12531 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012532
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012533no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012534 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012535 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012536 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012537 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012538 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12539 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012540
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012541no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012543 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012544 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012545 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012546 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12547 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012548
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012549no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012551 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012552 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012553 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012554 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12555 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012556
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012557no-tlsv13
12558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12559 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12560 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12561 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012562 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12563 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012564
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012565npn <protocols>
12566 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12567 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12568 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012569 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012570 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012571 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12572 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12573 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12574 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12575 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012576
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012577prefer-client-ciphers
12578 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12579 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12580 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012581 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12582 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12583 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012584
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012585process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012586 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012587 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012588 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012589 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12590 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12591 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12592 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012593 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012594 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12595 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12596 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12597 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12598 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012599
12600 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12601
12602 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12603 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12604 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12605 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12606 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12607 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12608 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12609 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012610
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012611proto <name>
12612 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12613 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12614 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12615 in haproxy -vv.
12616 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12617 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012618 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012619 h2" on the bind line.
12620
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012621ssl
12622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012623 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012624 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12625 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012626 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12627 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012628
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012629ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12630 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012631 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12632 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12633 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012634 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12635
12636ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012637 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12638 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12639 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12640 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012641
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012642strict-sni
12643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12644 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12645 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12646 See the "crt" option for more information.
12647
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012648tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012649 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012650 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12651 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012652 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012653 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12654 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12655 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12656 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12657 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12658 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12659 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12660
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012661tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012662 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012663 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12664 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12665 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12666 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12667 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12668 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12669 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012670 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12671 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12672 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012673
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012674tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12675 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012676 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12677 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12678 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12679 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12680 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12681 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12682 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12683 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12684 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12685 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012686 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12687 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12688
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012689transparent
12690 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12691 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12692 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12693 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12694 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12695 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12696 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12697 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12698 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12699 so check for support with your vendor.
12700
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012701v4v6
12702 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12703 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12704 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12705 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012706 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012707
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012708v6only
12709 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12710 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12711 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012712 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12713 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012714
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012715uid <uid>
12716 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12717 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12718 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12719 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12720 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12721
12722user <user>
12723 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12724 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12725 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12726 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12727 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12728
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012729verify [none|optional|required]
12730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12731 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12732 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12733 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12734 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012735 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12736 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12737 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12738 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012739
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200127405.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012741------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012743The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12744which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12745arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12746settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12747after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12748Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12749address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012751 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012752 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012753
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012754Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12755keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012757The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012758
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012759addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012760 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012761 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12762 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12763 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12764 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12765 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012766
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012767agent-check
12768 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012769 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012770 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12771 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12772 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012773
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012774 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012775 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012776 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12777 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12778 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012779
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012780 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12781 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12782 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12783 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12784 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012785
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012786 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012787 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012788
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012789 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12790 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12791 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012792
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012793 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12794 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12795 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012796
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012797 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12798 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12799 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12800 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12801 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012802 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012803 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012804
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012805 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12806 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012807
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012808 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12809 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12810 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12811 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12812 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12813 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12814 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12815 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12816 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012817
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012818 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12819 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012820 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12821 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12822 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012823 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012824
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012825 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012826 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012827
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012828agent-send <string>
12829 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12830 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12831 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12832 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12833 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12834
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012835agent-inter <delay>
12836 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12837 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12838
12839 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12840 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12841 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12842 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12843 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12844 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12845 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12846 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12847 of backends use the same servers.
12848
12849 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12850
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012851agent-addr <addr>
12852 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12853
12854 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12855 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12856 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12857 hostname, it will be resolved.
12858
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012859agent-port <port>
12860 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12861
12862 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12863
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012864allow-0rtt
12865 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012866 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12867 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012868
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012869alpn <protocols>
12870 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12871 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12872 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012873 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012874 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12875 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12876 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12877 now obsolete NPN extension.
12878 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12879 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12880
12881 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012883backup
12884 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12885 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12886 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12887 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012888 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12889 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012890
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012891ca-file <cafile>
12892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12893 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12894 server's certificate.
12895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012896check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012897 This option enables health checks on a server:
12898 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12899 considered available.
12900 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12901 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12902 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12903 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12904 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12905 set.
12906 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12907 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12908 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12909 exchanges succeed.
12910
12911 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12912 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12913 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12914 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12915 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012916 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012917 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12918
12919 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12920 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12921
12922 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12923 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12924
12925 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12926 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12927 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12928 available.
12929
12930 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12931 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12932 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12933
12934 Example:
12935 # simple tcp check
12936 backend foo
12937 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12938 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12939 backend foo
12940 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12941 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12942 backend foo
12943 option tcp-check
12944 tcp-check connect
12945 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012946
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012947check-send-proxy
12948 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12949 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12950 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12951 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12952 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12953 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12954 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12955
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012956check-alpn <protocols>
12957 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12958 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12959 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12960
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012961check-proto <name>
12962 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12963 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12964 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12965 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12966 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12967 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12968 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12969
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012970check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012971 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012972 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12973 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012974
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012975check-ssl
12976 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12977 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12978 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12979 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012980 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012981 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12982 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012983 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012984 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12985 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012986
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012987check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012988 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012989 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12990 for normal traffic.
12991
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012992ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12994 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12995 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012996 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12997 information and recommendations see e.g.
12998 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12999 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13000 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013001
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013002ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13004 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13005 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13006 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013007 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13008 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13009 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013011cookie <value>
13012 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13013 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13014 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13015 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13016 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13017 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13018 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13019
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013020crl-file <crlfile>
13021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13022 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13023 to verify server's certificate.
13024
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013025crt <cert>
13026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13027 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13028 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13029 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13030 certificate request.
13031
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013032disabled
13033 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13034 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13035 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13036 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13037 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013038 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013039
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013040enabled
13041 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13042 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13043 default value.
13044 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13045 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013047error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013048 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13049 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13050 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013052 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013054fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013055 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13056 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13057 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13058
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013059force-sslv3
13060 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13061 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013062 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013063 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013064
13065force-tlsv10
13066 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013067 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013068 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013069
13070force-tlsv11
13071 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013072 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013073 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013074
13075force-tlsv12
13076 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013077 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013078 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013079
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013080force-tlsv13
13081 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13082 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013083 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013085id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013086 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13087 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13088 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013089
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013090init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13091 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13092 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013093 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013094 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13095 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13096 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13097 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13098 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13099 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13100 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13101 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13102 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013103 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013104 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13105 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13106 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13107 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13108 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13109 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013110 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013111
13112 Example:
13113 defaults
13114 # never fail on address resolution
13115 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13116
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013117inter <delay>
13118fastinter <delay>
13119downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013120 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13121 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13122 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13123 between checks depending on the server state :
13124
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013125 Server state | Interval used
13126 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13127 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13128 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13129 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13130 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13131 or yet unchecked. |
13132 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13133 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13134 | "inter" otherwise.
13135 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013137 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13138 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13139 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13140 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013141 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13142 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13143 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13144 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13145 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013146
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013147log-proto <logproto>
13148 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13149 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13150 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13151 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13152
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013153maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013154 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13155 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013156 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13157 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013158 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13159 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13160 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13161 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13162
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013163 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13164 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13165 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13166 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13167 than 50 concurrent requests.
13168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013169maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013170 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13171 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13172 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13173 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13174 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13175 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13176 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13177
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013178max-reuse <count>
13179 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13180 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13181 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13182 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13183 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13184 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13185 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13186 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13187
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013188minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013189 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13190 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13191 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13192 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13193 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13194 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013195 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013196 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013197
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013198namespace <name>
13199 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13200 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13201 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13202 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13203
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013204no-agent-check
13205 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13206 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13207 default value.
13208 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13209 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13210
13211no-backup
13212 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13213 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13214 default value.
13215 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13216 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13217
13218no-check
13219 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13220 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13221 default value.
13222 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13223 "default-server" "check" setting.
13224
13225no-check-ssl
13226 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13227 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13228 default value.
13229 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13230 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13231
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013232no-send-proxy
13233 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13234 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13235 default value.
13236 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13237 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13238
13239no-send-proxy-v2
13240 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13241 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13242 default value.
13243 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13244 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13245
13246no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13247 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13248 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13249 default value.
13250 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13251 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13252
13253no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13254 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13255 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13256 default value.
13257 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13258 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13259
13260no-ssl
13261 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13262 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13263 default value.
13264 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13265 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13266
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013267no-ssl-reuse
13268 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13269 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13270 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13271 and for paranoid users.
13272
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013273no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013274 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13275 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013276 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013277
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013278 Supported in default-server: No
13279
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013280no-tls-tickets
13281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13282 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13283 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013284 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13285 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013286 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13287 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13288 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013289 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013290
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013291no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013292 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013293 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13294 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013295 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13296 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013297 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013298
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013299 Supported in default-server: No
13300
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013301no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013302 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013303 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13304 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013305 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13306 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013307 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013308
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013309 Supported in default-server: No
13310
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013311no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013312 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013313 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13314 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013315 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13316 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013317 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013318
13319 Supported in default-server: No
13320
13321no-tlsv13
13322 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13323 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13324 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13325 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13326 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013327 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013328
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013329 Supported in default-server: No
13330
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013331no-verifyhost
13332 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13333 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13334 default value.
13335 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13336 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013337
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013338no-tfo
13339 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13340 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13341 default value.
13342 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13343 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13344
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013345non-stick
13346 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13347 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13348 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13349
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013350npn <protocols>
13351 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13352 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13353 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013354 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013355 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13356 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13357 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013359observe <mode>
13360 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13361 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13362 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13363 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13364 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13365 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013366 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013367
13368 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013370on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013371 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13372 Currently, four modes are available:
13373 - fastinter: force fastinter
13374 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13375 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13376 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13377 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13378
13379 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13380
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013381on-marked-down <action>
13382 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13383 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013384 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13385 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13386 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13387 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13388 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13389 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13390 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13391 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013392
13393 Actions are disabled by default
13394
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013395on-marked-up <action>
13396 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13397 Currently one action is available:
13398 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13399 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13400 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13401 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013402 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13403 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013404 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13405 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13406
13407 Actions are disabled by default
13408
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013409pool-low-conn <max>
13410 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13411 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13412 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13413 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13414 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13415 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13416 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13417 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13418 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13419 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13420 applying to "http-reuse".
13421
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013422pool-max-conn <max>
13423 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13424 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13425 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13426 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13427 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13428 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13429
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013430pool-purge-delay <delay>
13431 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013432 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013433 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013435port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013436 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13437 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13438 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13439 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13440 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13441 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13442
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013443proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013444 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13445 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13446 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13447 reported in haproxy -vv.
13448 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13449 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013451redir <prefix>
13452 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13453 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13454 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13455 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13456 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13457 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13458 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13459 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013460 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013461 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013462 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13463 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13464 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13465 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13466
13467 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013469rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013470 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13471 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13472 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13473
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013474resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13475 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13476 server.
13477
13478 Available options:
13479
13480 * allow-dup-ip
13481 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13482 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13483 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13484 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13485 For such case, simply enable this option.
13486 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13487
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013488 * ignore-weight
13489 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13490 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13491 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13492
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013493 * prevent-dup-ip
13494 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13495 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13496 same fqdn.
13497 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13498
13499 Example:
13500 backend b_myapp
13501 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13502 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13503 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13504
13505 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13506 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13507 it
13508 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13509 different address
13510
13511 Default value: not set
13512
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013513resolve-prefer <family>
13514 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13515 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13516 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13517 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13518
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013519 Default value: ipv6
13520
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013521 Example:
13522
13523 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013524
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013525resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013526 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013527 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013528 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013529 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13530 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013531 configured network, another address is selected.
13532
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013533 Example:
13534
13535 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013536
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013537resolvers <id>
13538 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13539 hostname.
13540
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013541 Example:
13542
13543 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013544
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013545 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013546
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013547send-proxy
13548 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13549 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13550 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13551 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013552 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13553 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13554 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13555 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13556 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13557 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13558 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13559 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13560 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13561 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013562 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13563 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013564
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013565send-proxy-v2
13566 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13567 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13568 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13569 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013570 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13571 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13572 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13573 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013574
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013575proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013576 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13577 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13578
13579 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13580 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13581 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13582 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13583 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13584 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13585 connection is supported).
13586 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13587 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13588 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13589 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13590 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13591 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13592 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013593
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013594send-proxy-v2-ssl
13595 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13596 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13597 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13598 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13599 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13600 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13601 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013602 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13603 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013604
13605send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13606 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13607 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13608 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13609 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13610 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13611 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13612 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13613 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013614 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13615 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013617slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013618 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13619 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13620 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13621 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13622 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13623 parameters :
13624
13625 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13626 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13627
13628 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13629 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13630 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13631 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13632
13633 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13634 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13635 seen as failed.
13636
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013637sni <expression>
13638 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13639 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13640 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13641 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013642 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13643 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013644 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013645 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13646 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013647
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013648source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013649source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013650source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013651 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13652 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13653 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13654 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13655
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013656 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13657 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13658 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13659 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13660 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13661 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13662 server.
13663
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013664 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13665 specifying the source address without port(s).
13666
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013667ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013668 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13669 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13670 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13671 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13672 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13673 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013674 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13675 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013676
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013677ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13678 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13679 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13680 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13681
13682ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13683 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13684 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13685 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13686
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013687ssl-reuse
13688 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13689 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13690 default value.
13691 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13692 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13693
13694stick
13695 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13696 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13697 default value.
13698 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13699 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013700
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013701socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013702 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013703 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13704 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13705
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013706tcp-ut <delay>
13707 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13708 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13709 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013710 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013711 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13712 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13713 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13714 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13715 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13716 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13717 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13718 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13719 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13720
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013721tfo
13722 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13723 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13724 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13725 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13726 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013727 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013729track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013730 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13731 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13732 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13733 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013734 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13735
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013736tls-tickets
13737 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13738 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13739 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013740 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13741 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13742 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013743 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013744 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013745
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013746verify [none|required]
13747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013748 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013749 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13750 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013751 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013752 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13753 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13754 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13755 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13756 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13757 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13758 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13759 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013760
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013761verifyhost <hostname>
13762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013763 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13764 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13765 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13766 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13767 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13768 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13769 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13770 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013772weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013773 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13774 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13775 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013776 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13777 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13778 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13779 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13780 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13781 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013782
13783
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137845.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13785-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013786
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013787HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13788using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13789configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013790This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13791can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13792workload.
13793This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13794resolution at run time.
13795Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13796carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13797
13798
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137995.3.1. Global overview
13800----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013801
13802As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13803different steps of the process life:
13804
13805 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13806 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13807 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13808
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013809 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13810 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013811
13812A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13813 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13814 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13815 resolution to know this new IP.
13816
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013817When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013818HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013819SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13820from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13821will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13822will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013823
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013824A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013825 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013826 first valid response.
13827
13828 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13829 servers return an error.
13830
13831
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138325.3.2. The resolvers section
13833----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013834
13835This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013836HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13837contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013838
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013839When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13840uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13841is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13842answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13843
13844When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013845used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013846
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013847 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13848 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13849 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013850
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013851 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13852 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013853
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013854 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13855 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13856 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013857
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013858For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13859following scenarios are possible:
13860
13861 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13862 ignored
13863
13864 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13865 applied
13866
13867 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13868 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13869
13870 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13871 retries the query with a new type
13872
13873 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13874 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013875
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013876As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13877a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013878<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013879
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013880
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013881resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013882 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013883
13884A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13885
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013886accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013887 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013888 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013889 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13890 by RFC 6891)
13891
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013892 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13893
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013894nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13895 DNS server description:
13896 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13897 <ip> : IP address of the server
13898 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13899
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013900parse-resolv-conf
13901 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13902 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13903 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13904
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013905hold <status> <period>
13906 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13907 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013908 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013909 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013910 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13911 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13912 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13913
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013914 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013915
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013916resolve_retries <nb>
13917 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13918 giving up.
13919 Default value: 3
13920
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013921 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13922 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13923 type.
13924
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013925timeout <event> <time>
13926 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13927 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13928 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013929 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13930 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013931 Default value: 1s
13932 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013933 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013934 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013935 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13936 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13937
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013938 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013939
13940 resolvers mydns
13941 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13942 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013943 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013944 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013945 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013946 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013947 hold other 30s
13948 hold refused 30s
13949 hold nx 30s
13950 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013951 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013952 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013953
13954
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200139556. Cache
13956---------
13957
13958HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13959(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13960RAM.
13961
13962The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13963this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13964
13965If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13966independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13967when we try to allocate a new one.
13968
13969The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13970
13971It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13972"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13973for more details.
13974
13975When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13976replaced by "<CACHE>".
13977
13978
139796.1. Limitation
13980----------------
13981
13982The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13983
13984- If the response is not a 200
13985- If the response contains a Vary header
13986- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13987- If the response is not cacheable
13988
13989- If the request is not a GET
13990- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13991- If the request contains an Authorization header
13992
13993
139946.2. Setup
13995-----------
13996
13997To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13998the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13999
14000
140016.2.1. Cache section
14002---------------------
14003
14004cache <name>
14005 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14006 size of cache is mandatory.
14007
14008total-max-size <megabytes>
14009 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14010 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14011
14012max-object-size <bytes>
14013 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14014 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14015 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14016
14017max-age <seconds>
14018 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14019 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14020 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14021 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14022 default.
14023
14024
140256.2.2. Proxy section
14026---------------------
14027
14028http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14029 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14030 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14031 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14032 after this one.
14033
14034http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14035 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14036 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14037 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14038 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14039
14040
14041Example:
14042
14043 backend bck1
14044 mode http
14045
14046 http-request cache-use foobar
14047 http-response cache-store foobar
14048 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14049
14050 cache foobar
14051 total-max-size 4
14052 max-age 240
14053
14054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140557. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14056----------------------------------
14057
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014058HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014059client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14060The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14061these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14062but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14063data called patterns.
14064
14065
140667.1. ACL basics
14067---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014068
14069The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14070content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14071from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14072simple :
14073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014074 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014075 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014076 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14077 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014079The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14080adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014081
14082In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014085
14086This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14087Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14088and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014089an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14090conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14091as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14092are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014093
14094ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14095'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14096which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14097
14098There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14099performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014101The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14102specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14103this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014104methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14105ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014106
14107Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14108 - boolean
14109 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14110 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14111 - string
14112 - data block
14113
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014114Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14115converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14116would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14117The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14118which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14119
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014120Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14121keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14122fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14123which are summarized in the table below :
14124
14125 +---------------------+-----------------+
14126 | Sample or converter | Default |
14127 | output type | matching method |
14128 +---------------------+-----------------+
14129 | boolean | bool |
14130 +---------------------+-----------------+
14131 | integer | int |
14132 +---------------------+-----------------+
14133 | ip | ip |
14134 +---------------------+-----------------+
14135 | string | str |
14136 +---------------------+-----------------+
14137 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14138 +---------------------+-----------------+
14139
14140Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14141matching method, see below.
14142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014143The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14144 - boolean
14145 - integer or integer range
14146 - IP address / network
14147 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14148 - regular expression
14149 - hex block
14150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014151The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14152
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014153 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14154 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014155 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014156 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014157 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014158 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014159 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014161The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14162read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14163if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14164lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14165will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14166beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14167a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14168lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14169exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14170
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014171The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14172parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14173ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14174a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14175check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14176
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014177The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14178socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14179file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14182loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14183
14184 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14185
14186In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14187the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14188case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14189as well.
14190
14191The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14192sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14193do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14194methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14195is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014196obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014197followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14198default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14199that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14200string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14201
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014202The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14203By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14204string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14205resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14206server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014207waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014208flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14209function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014211There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14212sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14213be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014214
14215 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14216 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014217 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14218 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14219 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14220 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014221
14222 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14223 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014225
14226 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014228
14229 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014230 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014231
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014232 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014233 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14234
14235 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14236 binary or string samples.
14237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014238 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14239 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014241 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14242 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14243 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014245 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14246 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014248 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14249 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014251 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14252 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14255 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014256 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14259 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14260 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014261
14262For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14263request, it is possible to do :
14264
14265 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14266
14267In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14268buffer, one would use the following acl :
14269
14270 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14271
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014272On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14273possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14274
14275 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014277All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14278criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14279method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14280to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14281criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14282the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014284If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014285the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14286For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14289 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14290 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14291 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014292
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014293
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014294The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14295types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14296combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14297brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14298default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014300 +-------------------------------------------------+
14301 | Input sample type |
14302 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014303 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014304 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14305 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14306 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014307 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014308 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014309 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014311 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014313 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014314 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014315 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014316 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014317 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014319 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014321 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014323 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014324 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014325 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014327 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14329 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14330 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014331
14332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143337.1.1. Matching booleans
14334------------------------
14335
14336In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14337Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14338When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14339that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14340
14341Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14342return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14343"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143467.1.2. Matching integers
14347------------------------
14348
14349Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14350enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14351to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14352
14353Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14354matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14355lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014356
14357For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14358unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14359representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14360
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014361As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14362two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14363instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14364ranges and operators.
14365
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014366For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014367operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14368Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14369of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014371Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014372
14373 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14374 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14375 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14376 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14377 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014379For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014380
14381 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14382
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014383This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14384
14385 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14386
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143887.1.3. Matching strings
14389-----------------------
14390
14391String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14392different forms :
14393
14394 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014395 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014396
14397 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014398 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014399
14400 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14401 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14402
14403 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14404 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14405
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014406 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014407 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14408 matches.
14409
14410 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14411 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14412 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014413
14414String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14415exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14416characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14417string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14418to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014419before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014420
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014421Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14422(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14423Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14424
14425Example:
14426 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14427 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14428
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144307.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14431---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014432
14433Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14434they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14435possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14436passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14437the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014438the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14439match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014440
14441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144427.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14443-------------------------------------
14444
14445It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14446not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14447a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14448to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14449digits may be used upper or lower case.
14450
14451Example :
14452 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14453 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14454
14455
144567.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14457---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014458
14459IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14460netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14461within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014462host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014463difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14464at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14465does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14466parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014467
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014468The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14469abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14470
14471 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14472 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14473 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14474 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14475 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14476 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14477 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14478 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14479
14480Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14481192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14482
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014483IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14484Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14485trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14486IPv6 patterns.
14487
14488HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14489following situations :
14490 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14491 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14492 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14493 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14494 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14495 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14496 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14497 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14498 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14499 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501
145027.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14503----------------------------------
14504
14505Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14506combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14507
14508 - AND (implicit)
14509 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14510 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014514 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14517indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014519For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14520"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14521requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14522is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14523
14524 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014525 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14526 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14527 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528
14529To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14530and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14531
14532 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14533 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14534 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14535 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14536
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014537 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014538 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14539 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14540 use_backend www if host_www
14541
14542It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14543expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14544be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14545the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14546
14547 The following rule :
14548
14549 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014550 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551
14552 Can also be written that way :
14553
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014554 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555
14556It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14557to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14558simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14559sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14560good use is the following :
14561
14562 With named ACLs :
14563
14564 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14565 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14566 monitor fail if site_dead
14567
14568 With anonymous ACLs :
14569
14570 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14571
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014572See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14573keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574
14575
145767.3. Fetching samples
14577---------------------
14578
14579Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14580against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14581sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14582ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14583of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14584available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14585
14586This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14587Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14588compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14589deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14590
14591The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14592matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14593method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14594indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14595
14596As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14597when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14598mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14599the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14600ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14601
14602Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14603multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14604when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014605incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14606are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014607is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14608all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14609
14610Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14611 - name
14612 - name(arg1)
14613 - name(arg1,arg2)
14614
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014615
146167.3.1. Converters
14617-----------------
14618
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014619Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14620of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14621is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14622was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014623has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014624unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14625
14626These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14627sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14628the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014629support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014630
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014631A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14632support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14633supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14634(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14635bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014637The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014638
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001463951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14640 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14641 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14642 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14643 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14644 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14645
14646 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014647 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14648 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014649 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14650 frontend http-in
14651 bind *:8081
14652 default_backend servers
14653 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14654 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14655
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014656add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014657 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014658 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014659 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14660 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14663 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14664 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14665 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014666 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014667 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014668
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014669aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14670 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14671 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14672 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14673 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14674 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14675 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14676
14677 Example:
14678 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14679 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14680
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014681and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014682 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014683 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014684 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14685 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014686 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014687 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14688 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14689 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14690 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014691 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014692 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014693
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014694b64dec
14695 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14696 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14697
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014698base64
14699 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014700 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014701 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14702
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014703bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014704 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014705 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014706 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014707 presence of a flag).
14708
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014709bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14710 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14711 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014712 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014713
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014714concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14715 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14716 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14717 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14718 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14719 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14720 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14721 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14722 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14723 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14724 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014725 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14726 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14727 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14728 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014729
14730 Example:
14731 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14732 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14733 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014734 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014735 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14736
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014737cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014738 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14739 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014740
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014741crc32([<avalanche>])
14742 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14743 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14744 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14745 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14746 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14747 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14748 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14749 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14750 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14751 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014752 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14753
14754crc32c([<avalanche>])
14755 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14756 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14757 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14758 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14759 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14760 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14761 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14762 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014763
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014764cut_crlf
14765 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14766 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14767 updated.
14768
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014769da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014770 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14771 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14772 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14773 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014774 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014775 configuration language.
14776
14777 Example:
14778 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014779 bind *:8881
14780 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014781 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014782
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014783debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14784 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14785 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14786 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14787 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14788 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14789 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14790 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14791 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14792 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14793 printable sample types.
14794
14795 Example:
14796 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014797
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014798digest(<algorithm>)
14799 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14800 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14801
14802 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14803 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14804
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014805div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014806 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14807 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014808 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014809 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14810 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014811 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014812 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14813 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14814 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14815 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014816 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014817 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014818
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014819djb2([<avalanche>])
14820 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14821 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14822 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14823 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14824 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14825 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14826 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014827 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14828 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014829
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014830even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014831 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014832 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14833
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014834field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14835 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14836 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14837 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14838 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14839 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14840 fields.
14841
14842 Example :
14843 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14844 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14845 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14846 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14847 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014848
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014849hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014850 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014851 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014852 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014853 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014854
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014855hex2i
14856 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014857 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014858
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014859htonl
14860 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14861 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14862 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14863 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14864
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014865hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14866 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14867 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14868 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14869 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14870
14871 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14872 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14873
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014874http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014875 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14876 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014877 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14878 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14879 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14880 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14881 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14882 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14883 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14884 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014886in_table(<table>)
14887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14889 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014890 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014891 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14892
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014893ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14894 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014895 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014896 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14897 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14898 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14899 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14900 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014901
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014902json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014903 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014904 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014905 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014906 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14907 of errors:
14908 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14909 bytes, ...)
14910 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14911 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14912
14913 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14914 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14915 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14916 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14917 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14918 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014919 - "ascii" : never fails;
14920 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14921 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014922 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014923 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014924 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14925 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14926
14927 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014928 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014929
14930 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014931 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014932 capture request header user-agent len 150
14933 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014934
14935 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14936 GET / HTTP/1.0
14937 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14938
14939 Output log:
14940 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14941
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014942language(<value>[,<default>])
14943 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14944 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14945 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14946 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14947 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14948 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14949 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14950 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14951 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014952 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014953 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14954 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014955
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014956 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014957
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014958 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14959 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014960
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014961 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14962 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14963 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14964 use_backend spanish if es
14965 use_backend french if fr
14966 use_backend english if en
14967 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014968
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014969length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014970 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14971 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14972 type. The result is of type integer.
14973
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014974lower
14975 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14976 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14977 type. The result is of type string.
14978
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014979ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14980 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14981 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14982 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14983 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14984 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14985 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14986
14987 Example :
14988
14989 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014990 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014991 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14992
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014993ltrim(<chars>)
14994 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14995 representation of the input sample.
14996
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014997map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14998map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14999map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15000 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15001 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15002 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15003 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15004 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15005 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15006 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15007 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015008
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015009 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15010 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15011 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015012
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015013 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015014 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015016 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15017 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15018 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15019 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015020 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15021 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015022 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15023 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15024 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15025 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15026 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15027 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15028 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15029 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015030 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15031 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15032 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015033 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15034 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15035 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15036 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15037 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015038
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015039 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15040 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15041 the corresponding match text.
15042
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015043 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15044 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15045 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15046 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15047 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015049 Example :
15050
15051 # this is a comment and is ignored
15052 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15053 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15054 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15055 | | | `---------- value
15056 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15057 | `---------------------------- key
15058 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15059
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015060mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015061 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15062 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015063 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015064 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015065 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015066 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15067 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15068 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15069 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015070 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015071 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015072
15073mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015074 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015075 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15076 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015077 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015078 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015079 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015080 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15081 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15082 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15083 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015084 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015085 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015086
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015087nbsrv
15088 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15089 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15090 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15091 map lookup.
15092
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015093neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015094 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15095 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15096 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15097 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015098
15099not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015100 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015101 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015102 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015103 absence of a flag).
15104
15105odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015106 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015107 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15108
15109or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015110 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015111 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015112 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15113 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015114 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015115 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15116 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15117 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15118 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015119 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015120 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015121
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015122protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15123 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15124 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15125 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15126 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15127 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15128 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15129 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15130 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15131 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15132 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15133 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15134
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015135regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015136 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15137 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15138 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15139 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15140 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15141 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15142 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15143 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15144 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015145 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15146 of characters with other ones.
15147
15148 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15149 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15150 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15151 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15152 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15153 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015154
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015155 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015156
15157 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15158 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15159 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015160 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015161
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015162 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15163 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15164
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015165 # capture groups and backreferences
15166 # both lines do the same.
15167 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15168 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15169
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015170capture-req(<id>)
15171 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15172 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15173
15174 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015175 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15176 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015177
15178capture-res(<id>)
15179 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15180 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15181
15182 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015183 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15184 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015185
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015186rtrim(<chars>)
15187 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15188 of the input sample.
15189
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015190sdbm([<avalanche>])
15191 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15192 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15193 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15194 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15195 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15196 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15197 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015198 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15199 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015200
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015201secure_memcmp(<var>)
15202 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15203 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15204 match.
15205
15206 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15207 performed in constant time.
15208
15209 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15210 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15211
15212 Example :
15213
15214 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15215 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15216 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15217 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15218
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015219set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015220 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15221 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15222 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015223 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015224 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15225 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015226 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015227 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15228 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015229 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015230 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015231
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015232sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015233 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015234 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15235
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015236sha2([<bits>])
15237 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15238 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15239
15240 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15241 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15242
15243 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15244 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15245
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015246srv_queue
15247 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15248 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15249 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15250 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15251 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15252
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015253strcmp(<var>)
15254 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15255 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15256 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15257 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15258 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15259 shorter).
15260
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015261 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15262 strings in constant time.
15263
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015264 Example :
15265
15266 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15267 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15268 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15269
15270
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015271sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015272 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15273 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015274 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015275 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15276 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015277 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015278 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15279 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015280 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015281 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15282 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015283 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015284 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015285
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015286table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15287 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15288 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15289 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15290 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15291 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15292 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15293
15294
15295table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15296 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15297 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15298 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15299 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15300 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15301 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15302
15303table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15304 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15305 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015306 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015307 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15308 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15309
15310table_conn_cur(<table>)
15311 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15312 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15313 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15314 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15315 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15316
15317table_conn_rate(<table>)
15318 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15319 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15320 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15321 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15322 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15323
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015324table_gpt0(<table>)
15325 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15326 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15327 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15328 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15329 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15330
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015331table_gpc0(<table>)
15332 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15333 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15334 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15335 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15336 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15337
15338table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15339 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15340 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15341 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15342 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15343 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15344 sample fetch keyword.
15345
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015346table_gpc1(<table>)
15347 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15348 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15349 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15350 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15351 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15352
15353table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15354 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15355 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15356 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15357 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15358 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15359 sample fetch keyword.
15360
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015361table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15362 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15363 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015364 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015365 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15366 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15367
15368table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15369 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15370 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15371 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15372 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15373 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15374 keyword.
15375
15376table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15377 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15378 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015379 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015380 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15381 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15382
15383table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15386 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15387 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15388 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15389 keyword.
15390
15391table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15392 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15393 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015394 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015395 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15396 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15397 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15398 keyword.
15399
15400table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15401 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15402 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015403 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015404 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15405 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15406 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15407 keyword.
15408
15409table_server_id(<table>)
15410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15412 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15413 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15414 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15415 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15416
15417table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15418 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15419 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015420 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015421 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15422 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15423 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15424 keyword.
15425
15426table_sess_rate(<table>)
15427 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15428 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15429 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15430 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15431 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15432 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15433 keyword.
15434
15435table_trackers(<table>)
15436 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15437 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15438 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15439 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15440 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15441 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15442 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15443 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15444 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15445 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15446
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015447upper
15448 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15449 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15450 type. The result is of type string.
15451
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015452url_dec([<in_form>])
15453 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15454 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15455 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15456 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15457 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15458 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015459
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015460ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015461 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015462 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15463 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15464 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015465 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15466 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15467 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15468 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015469 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015470 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15471 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015472
15473 Example:
15474 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15475 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15476
15477 message Point {
15478 int32 latitude = 1;
15479 int32 longitude = 2;
15480 }
15481
15482 message PPoint {
15483 Point point = 59;
15484 }
15485
15486 message Rectangle {
15487 // One corner of the rectangle.
15488 PPoint lo = 48;
15489 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15490 PPoint hi = 49;
15491 }
15492
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015493 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15494 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15495 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015496
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015497 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15498 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015499 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015500 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15501
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015502 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015503
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015504 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015505
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015506 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15507 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15508 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015509
15510 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15511 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15512 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15513
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015514 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15515 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15516 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015517
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015518
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015519unset-var(<var name>)
15520 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15521 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15522 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15523 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15524 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15525 response),
15526 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15527 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15528 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15529 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15530
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015531utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15532 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15533 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15534 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15535 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15536 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15537 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15538
15539 Example :
15540
15541 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015542 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015543 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15544
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015545word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15546 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15547 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15548 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015549 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015550 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15551 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15552
15553 Example :
15554 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15555 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15556 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15557 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15558 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015559 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015560
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015561wt6([<avalanche>])
15562 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15563 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15564 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15565 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15566 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15567 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15568 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015569 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15570 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015571
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015572xor(<value>)
15573 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015574 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015575 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015576 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015577 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015578 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15579 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015580 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015581 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15582 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015583 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015584 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015585
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015586xxh32([<seed>])
15587 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15588 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15589 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15590 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15591 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15592 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15593 as cryptographically secure.
15594
15595xxh64([<seed>])
15596 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15597 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15598 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15599 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15600 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15601 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15602 as cryptographically secure.
15603
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015604
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156057.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606--------------------------------------------
15607
15608A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15609not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15610"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15611The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15612
15613always_false : boolean
15614 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15615 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15616
15617always_true : boolean
15618 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15619 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15620
15621avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015622 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15624 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15625 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15626 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15627 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15628 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15629 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15630 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15631 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15632 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15633 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15634 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15635 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015638 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15639 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15640 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15641 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015642 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15643
15644be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15646 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15647 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15648 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15649 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015650 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15651 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015652
15653 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15654 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15655 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15658 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15659 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15660 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015661 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15663 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015664
15665 Example :
15666 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15667 backend dynamic
15668 mode http
15669 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15670 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015671
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015672bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015673 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15674 of the string.
15675
15676bool(<bool>) : bool
15677 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15678 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15681 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015682 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15684 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015685
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015686 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015687 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015688 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15689
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015690 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15691 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015692
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015693 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015694 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015696 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015697 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015699 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015700
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015701 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15702 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015704 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015705
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015706cpu_calls : integer
15707 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15708 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15709 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15710 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15711 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15712 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15713
15714cpu_ns_avg : integer
15715 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15716 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15717 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15718 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15719 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15720 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15721 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15722 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15723 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15724 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15725 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15726
15727cpu_ns_tot : integer
15728 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15729 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15730 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15731 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15732 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15733 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15734 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15735 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15736 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15737 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15738 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15739 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15740 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15741
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015742date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015743 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015744
15745 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15746 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15747 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015748 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15749
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015750 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15751 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15752 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15753 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15754 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15755
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015756 Example :
15757
15758 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15759 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015760
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015761 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15762 # millisecond granularity
15763 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15764
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015765date_us : integer
15766 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15767 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15768 from the same timeval structure.
15769
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015770distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15771 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15772 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15773 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15774 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15775 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15776 list of supported tokens.
15777
15778distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15779 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15780 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15781 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15782 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15783 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15784 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15785 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15786 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15787 supported tokens.
15788
15789 Example :
15790 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15791 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15792 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15793 # send large files to the big farm
15794 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15795
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015796env(<name>) : string
15797 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15798 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15799 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15800 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15801 certain way.
15802
15803 Examples :
15804 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15805 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15806
15807 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15808 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15811 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015812 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15813 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15815 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015816 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15818 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015819
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015820fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15821 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15822 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15823 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15826 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15827 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15828 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15829 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15830 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15831 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15832 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15833 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015834
15835 Example :
15836 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15837 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15838 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15839 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15840 frontend mail
15841 bind :25
15842 mode tcp
15843 maxconn 100
15844 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15845 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15846 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15847 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015848
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015849hostname : string
15850 Returns the system hostname.
15851
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015852int(<integer>) : signed integer
15853 Returns a signed integer.
15854
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015855ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15856 Returns an ipv4.
15857
15858ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15859 Returns an ipv6.
15860
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015861lat_ns_avg : integer
15862 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15863 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15864 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15865 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15866 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15867 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15868 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15869 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15870 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015871 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15872 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15873 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15874 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15875 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
15876 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015877
15878lat_ns_tot : integer
15879 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15880 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15881 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15882 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15883 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15884 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15885 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15886 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15887 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015888 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15889 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15890 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15891 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15892 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015893 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15894 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15895 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15896 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15897 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15898 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15899
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015900meth(<method>) : method
15901 Returns a method.
15902
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015903nbproc : integer
15904 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15905 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15906 and debugging purposes.
15907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15909 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15910 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15911 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015912 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15913 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15914 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015915
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015916prio_class : integer
15917 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15918 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15919 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15920
15921prio_offset : integer
15922 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15923 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15924 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15925 set-priority-offset".
15926
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015927proc : integer
15928 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15929 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15930 debugging purposes.
15931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015933 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15934 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15935 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15937 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15938 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15939 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15940 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15941
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015942rand([<range>]) : integer
15943 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15944 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15945 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15946 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15947 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15948
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015949uuid([<version>]) : string
15950 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15951 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15952 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15955 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15956 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15957 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15958 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15959 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015960 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15961 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15962
15963srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15964 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15965 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15966 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15967 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15968 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15969 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15970 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15971
15972 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15973 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974
15975srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15976 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15977 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15978 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015979 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015980 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15981 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15982 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15983
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015984srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15985 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15986 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15987 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15988 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15989 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15990 fetch methods.
15991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15993 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15994 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015995 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15997 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015998 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999 overloading servers).
16000
16001 Example :
16002 # Redirect to a separate back
16003 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16004 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16005 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16006
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016007stopping : boolean
16008 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16009 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16010 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16011
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016012str(<string>) : string
16013 Returns a string.
16014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16016 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16017 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16018
16019table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16020 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16021 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16022 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16023
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016024thread : integer
16025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16026 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16027 and debugging purposes.
16028
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016029var(<var-name>) : undefined
16030 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016031 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16032 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016033 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016034 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16035 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016036 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016037 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16038 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016039 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016040 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016041
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160427.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043----------------------------------
16044
16045The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16046closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16047methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16048sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16049TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016050the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16051counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016052"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16053used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16054can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16055Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16056table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16057tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16058currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016060bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016061 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16062 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16063 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016065be_id : integer
16066 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016067 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16068 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016070be_name : string
16071 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016072 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16073 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075dst : ip
16076 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16077 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16078 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16079 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016080 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16081 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16082 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16083 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16084 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16085 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086
16087dst_conn : integer
16088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16089 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16090 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16091 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16092 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16093 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16094 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16095 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016096
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016097dst_is_local : boolean
16098 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16099 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16100 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16101 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016103 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16104 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16105 it only once per connection.
16106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107dst_port : integer
16108 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16109 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16110 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16111 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16112 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16113 an HTTP header.
16114
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016115fc_http_major : integer
16116 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16117 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16118 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16119
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016120fc_pp_authority : string
16121 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16122 if any.
16123
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016124fc_pp_unique_id : string
16125 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16126 if any.
16127
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016128fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16129 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16130 header.
16131
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016132fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16133 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16134 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16135 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16136 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16137 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16138 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16139
16140fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16141 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16142 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16143 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16144 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16145 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16146 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16147
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016148fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016149 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16150 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16151 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16152 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16153
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016154fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016155 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16156 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16157 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16158 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16159
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016160fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016161 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16162 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16163 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16164 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16165
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016166fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016167 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16168 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16169 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16170 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16171
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016172fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016173 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16174 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16175 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16176 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16177
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016178fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016179 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16180 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16181 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16182 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16183
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016184fe_defbe : string
16185 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16186 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016188fe_id : integer
16189 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016190 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16192
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016193fe_name : string
16194 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16195 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16196 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16197
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016198sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016199sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16200sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16201sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016202 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16203 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16204 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16205
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016206sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016207sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16208sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16209sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016210 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16211 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16212 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16213
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016214sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016215sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16216sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16217sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016218 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16219 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016220 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16221 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16222 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016223
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016224 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016225 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16226 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016227 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16228 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16229 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016230 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16231 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16232
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016233sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16234sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16235sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16236sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16237 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16238 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16239 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16240 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16241 when a first ACL was verified.
16242
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016243sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016244sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16245sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16246sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016247 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016248 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16249
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016250sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016251sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16252sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16253sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016254 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16255 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16256 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16257
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016258sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016259sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16260sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16261sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016262 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16263 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16264 See also src_conn_rate.
16265
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016266sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016267sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16268sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16269sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016270 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016271 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016272
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016273sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16274sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16275sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16276sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16277 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16278 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16279
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016280sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16281sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16282sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16283sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16284 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16285 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16286
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016287sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016288sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16289sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16290sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016291 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16292 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16293 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016294 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16295 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16296 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016297
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016298sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16299sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16300sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16301sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16302 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16303 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16304 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16305 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16306 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16307 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16308
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016309sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016310sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16311sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16312sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016313 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016314 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16315 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16316
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016317sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016318sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16319sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16320sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016321 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16322 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16323 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16324 src_http_err_rate.
16325
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016326sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016327sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16328sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16329sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016330 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016331 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16332 src_http_req_cnt.
16333
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016334sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016335sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16336sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16337sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016338 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16339 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16340 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16341 src_http_req_rate.
16342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016343sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016344sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16345sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16346sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016347 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016348 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16349 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16350 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16351 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016352
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016353 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016354 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16355 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016356 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16357
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016358sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16359sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16360sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16361sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16362 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16363 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16364 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16365 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16366 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16367
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016368sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016369sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16370sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16371sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016372 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16373 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16374 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016376sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016377sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16378sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16379sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016380 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16381 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16382 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016384sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016385sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16386sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16387sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016388 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016389 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16390 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16391 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016392 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016393 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16394
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016395sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016396sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16397sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16398sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016399 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16400 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16401 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16402 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16403 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016404 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016405
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016406sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016407sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16408sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16409sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016410 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16411 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16412 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16413
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016414sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016415sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16416sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16417sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016418 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16419 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016420 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016421 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16422 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16424 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16425 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016427so_id : integer
16428 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16429 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16430 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016431
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016432so_name : string
16433 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16434 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16435 strings instead of integers.
16436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016437src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016438 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016439 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16440 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16441 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016442 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16443 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16444 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016445 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16446 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16447 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16448 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16449 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16450 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16451 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016452
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016453 Example:
16454 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16455 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16458 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16459 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16460 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016461 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16464 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16465 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016466 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016467 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16470 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16471 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16472 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16473 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16474 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16475 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016476
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016477 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016478 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16479 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16480 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16481 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016482 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016483 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16484 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16485
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016486src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16487 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16488 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16489 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16490 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16491 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16492 was verified.
16493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016494src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016495 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016496 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016497 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016498 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016500src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016501 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16503 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016504 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016506src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16507 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16508 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16509 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016510 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016513 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016514 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016515 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016516 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016517
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016518src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16519 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16520 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16521 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16522 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16523
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016524src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16525 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16526 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16527 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16528 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016530src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016531 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016532 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016533 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16534 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016535 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16536 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16537 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016538
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016539src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16540 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16541 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16542 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16543 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16544 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16545 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16546 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016548src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016549 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016551 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016552 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016553 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016555src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16556 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16557 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16558 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16559 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016560 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016563 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016564 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16565 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016566 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016568src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16569 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16570 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16571 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016572 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016573 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16576 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16577 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16578 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016579 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16581 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016582
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016583 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016584 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016585 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016586 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016587
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016588src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16589 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16590 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16591 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16592 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16593 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16594 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16595
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016596src_is_local : boolean
16597 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16598 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16599 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16600 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016601 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016602 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16603 once per connection.
16604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016606 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16607 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16608 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16609 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16610 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016612src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016613 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16614 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16615 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16616 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16617 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016619src_port : integer
16620 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16621 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16622 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16623 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016626 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016627 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16628 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16629 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016630 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016632src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16633 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16634 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16635 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16636 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016637 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016639src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16640 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16641 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16642 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16643 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16644 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16645 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16646 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16647 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016648
16649 Example :
16650 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16651 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16652 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16653 listen ssh
16654 bind :22
16655 mode tcp
16656 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016657 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016658 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016659 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661srv_id : integer
16662 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16663 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016664 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016665
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016666srv_name : string
16667 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16668 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016669 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016670
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166717.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016674The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16675closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16676when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16677usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016678future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016679
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001668051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16681 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16682 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16683 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16684 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16685 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16686
16687 Example :
16688 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16689 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16690 # the request.
16691 frontend http-in
16692 bind *:8081
16693 default_backend servers
16694 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16695 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16696
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016697ssl_bc : boolean
16698 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16699 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016700 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16701 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016702
16703ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16704 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016705 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16706 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016707
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016708ssl_bc_alpn : string
16709 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16710 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016711 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016712 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16713 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16714 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16715 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16716 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016717 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16718 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016719
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016720ssl_bc_cipher : string
16721 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016722 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16723 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016724
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016725ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16726 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16727 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16728 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016729 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016730
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016731ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16732 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16733 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016734 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16735 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016736
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016737ssl_bc_npn : string
16738 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16739 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016740 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016741 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16742 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16743 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16744 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016745 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16746 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016747
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016748ssl_bc_protocol : string
16749 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016750 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16751 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016752
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016753ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016754 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016755 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016756 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16757 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016758
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016759ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16760 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16761 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16762 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016763 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016764
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016765ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16766 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16767 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016768 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16769 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016770
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016771ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16772 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16773 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16774 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016775 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016776
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016777ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16778 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016779 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16780 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016782ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16783 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16784 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16785 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16786 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16787 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016789ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16790 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16791 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16792 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16793 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016794
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016795ssl_c_der : binary
16796 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16797 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16798 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016800ssl_c_err : integer
16801 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16802 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16803 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16804 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16805 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016806
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016807ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016808 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16809 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16810 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16811 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16812 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16813 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16814 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16815 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016816 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16817 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16818 LDAP v3.
16819 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16820 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822ssl_c_key_alg : string
16823 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16824 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16825 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016827ssl_c_notafter : string
16828 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16829 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16830 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832ssl_c_notbefore : string
16833 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16834 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16835 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016836
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016837ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016838 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16839 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16840 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16841 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16842 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16843 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16844 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16845 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016846 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16847 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16848 LDAP v3.
16849 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16850 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016852ssl_c_serial : binary
16853 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16854 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16855 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016857ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16858 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16859 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16860 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016861 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16862 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16863
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016864 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016865 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16868 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16869 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16870 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016872ssl_c_used : boolean
16873 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16874 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876ssl_c_verify : integer
16877 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16878 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16879 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16880 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882ssl_c_version : integer
16883 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16884 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016885
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016886ssl_f_der : binary
16887 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16888 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16889 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16890
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016891ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016892 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16893 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16894 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16895 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016896 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016897 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16898 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16899 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016900 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16901 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16902 LDAP v3.
16903 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16904 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016906ssl_f_key_alg : string
16907 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16908 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16909 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911ssl_f_notafter : string
16912 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16913 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16914 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016916ssl_f_notbefore : string
16917 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16918 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16919 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016920
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016921ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016922 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16923 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16924 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16925 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16926 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16927 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16928 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16929 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016930 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16931 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16932 LDAP v3.
16933 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16934 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016936ssl_f_serial : binary
16937 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16938 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16939 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016940
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016941ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16942 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16943 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16944 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16947 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16948 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16949 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016951ssl_f_version : integer
16952 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16953 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16954
16955ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016956 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16957 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16958 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016960 Example :
16961 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16962 listen http-https
16963 bind :80
16964 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16965 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16966
16967ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16968 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16969 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16970
16971ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016972 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016973 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16974 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16975 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16976 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16977 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16978 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16979 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16980 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016982ssl_fc_cipher : string
16983 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16984 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016985
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016986ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16987 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16988 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016989 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016990
16991ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16992 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16993 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016994 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016995
16996ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16997 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16998 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16999 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017000 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017001 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017002
17003ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17004 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17005 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017006 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017007
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017008ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17009 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17010 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17011 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017013ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017014 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17015 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017016 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17017 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17018 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17019 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017020
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017021ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17022 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17023 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17024 wait until the handshake happened.
17025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017026ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17027 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017028 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17029 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017030 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017031 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017032
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017033ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017034 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017035 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17036 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017038ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017039 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017040 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17041 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17042 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17043 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17044 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17045 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17046 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048ssl_fc_protocol : string
17049 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17050 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017051
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017052ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017053 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017054 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17055 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017056
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017057ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17058 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17059 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17060 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017062ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17063 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17064 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17065 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17066 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017067
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017068ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17069 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17070 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17071 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17072 BoringSSL.
17073
17074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017075ssl_fc_sni : string
17076 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17077 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17078 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17079 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17080 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17081
17082 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17083 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17084 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017085 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017086 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017088 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017089 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17090 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017092ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17093 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17094 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017095
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017096ssl_s_der : binary
17097 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17098 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17099 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17100
17101ssl_s_key_alg : string
17102 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17103 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17104 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17105
17106ssl_s_notafter : string
17107 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17108 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17109 transport layer.
17110
17111ssl_s_notbefore : string
17112 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17113 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17114 transport layer.
17115
17116ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17117 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17118 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17119 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17120 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17121 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17122 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017123 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17124 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017125 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17126 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17127 LDAP v3.
17128 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17129 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17130
17131ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17132 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17133 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17134 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17135 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17136 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17137 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017138 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17139 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017140 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17141 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17142 LDAP v3.
17143 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17144 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17145
17146ssl_s_serial : binary
17147 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17148 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17149 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17150
17151ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17152 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17153 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17154 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17155
17156ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17157 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17158 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17159 layer.
17160
17161ssl_s_version : integer
17162 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17163 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017164
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171657.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017166------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017168Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17169sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17170only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17171For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17172be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17173can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17174sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17175for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17176content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017179 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17181 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017183payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17184 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017185 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017186 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017187
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017188req.hdrs : string
17189 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17190 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17191 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17192 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17193
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017194req.hdrs_bin : binary
17195 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17196 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17197 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17198 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17199 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17200 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17201
17202 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17203
17204 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17205 str: <int:length><bytes>
17206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017207req.len : integer
17208req_len : integer (deprecated)
17209 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17210 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17211 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17212 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17213 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17214 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17215 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17216 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017218req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17219 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017220 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17221 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17222 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17223 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017225 ACL alternatives :
17226 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017228req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17229 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17230 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17231 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17232 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017234 ACL alternatives :
17235 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017237 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239req.proto_http : boolean
17240req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17241 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17242 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17243 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17244 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17245 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17246 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17247 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249 Example:
17250 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17251 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17252 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017253 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017255req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17256rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17257 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17258 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17259 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17260 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17261 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17262 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17263 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017265 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17266 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17267 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17268 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17269 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17270 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272 ACL derivatives :
17273 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275 Example :
17276 listen tse-farm
17277 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17278 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17279 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17280 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17281 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17282 persist rdp-cookie
17283 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17284 # This is only useful makes sense if
17285 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17286 stick-table type string size 204800
17287 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17288 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17289 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017291 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17292 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017294req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17295rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17296 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17297 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17298 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17299 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301 ACL derivatives :
17302 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017303
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017304req.ssl_alpn : string
17305 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17306 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17307 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17308 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17309 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17310 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017311 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017312
17313 Examples :
17314 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17315 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17316 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017317 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017318 default_backend bk_default
17319
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017320req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17321 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17322 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017323 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17324 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17325 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17326 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17327 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017329req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17330req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17331 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17332 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17333 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17334 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17335 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17336 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17337 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017339req.ssl_sni : string
17340req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17341 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17342 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17343 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17344 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17345 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17346 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17347 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17348 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17349 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17350 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17351 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17352 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017354 ACL derivatives :
17355 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017357 Examples :
17358 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17359 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17360 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17361 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17362 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017363
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017364req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17365 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17366 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17367 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17368 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17369 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17370 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17371 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17372 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17373 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375req.ssl_ver : integer
17376req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17377 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17378 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17379 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17380 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17381 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17382 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17383 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017384 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017385 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017387 ACL derivatives :
17388 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017389
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017390res.len : integer
17391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17392 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17393 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17394 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17395 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17396 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17397 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017398 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17401 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017402 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017403 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017404 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017405 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017407res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17408 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17409 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17410 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017411 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17412 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017415
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017416res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17417rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17418 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17419 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17420 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17421 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17422 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17423 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17424 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017426wait_end : boolean
17427 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17428 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017429 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017430 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17431 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017432 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17434 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017436 Examples :
17437 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17438 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17439 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017441 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17442 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17443 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17444 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17445 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17446 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17447 tcp-request content reject
17448
17449
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174507.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017451--------------------------------------
17452
17453It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17454This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17455data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17456its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17457HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17458content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17459to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17460more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17461response are indexed.
17462
17463base : string
17464 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17465 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17466 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17467 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17468 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17469 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17470 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17471 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17472
17473 ACL derivatives :
17474 base : exact string match
17475 base_beg : prefix match
17476 base_dir : subdir match
17477 base_dom : domain match
17478 base_end : suffix match
17479 base_len : length match
17480 base_reg : regex match
17481 base_sub : substring match
17482
17483base32 : integer
17484 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17485 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17486 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017487 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17488 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17489 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490
17491base32+src : binary
17492 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17493 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17494 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17495 per-URL counters.
17496
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017497capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17498 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17499 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17500 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17501
17502capture.req.method : string
17503 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17504 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17505 because it's allocated.
17506
17507capture.req.uri : string
17508 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17509 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17510 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17511 allocated.
17512
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017513capture.req.ver : string
17514 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17515 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17516 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17517
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017518capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17519 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17520 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17521 The first entry is an index of 0.
17522 See also: "capture response header"
17523
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017524capture.res.ver : string
17525 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17526 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17527 persistent flag.
17528
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017529req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017530 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17531 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17532 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017533
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017534req.body_param([<name>) : string
17535 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17536 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17537 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17538 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17539 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17540 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17541 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17542 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17543 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17544 given.
17545
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017546req.body_len : integer
17547 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17548 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017549 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17550 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017551
17552req.body_size : integer
17553 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017554 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17555 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557req.cook([<name>]) : string
17558cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17559 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17560 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17561 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17562 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17563 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17564 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17565 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17566 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17567
17568 ACL derivatives :
17569 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17570 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17571 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17572 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17573 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17574 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17575 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17576 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017578req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17579cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17580 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17581 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17584cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17585 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17586 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17587 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17588 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017590cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17591 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17592 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17593 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17594 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017595 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17597 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17598 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17599 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017601hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17602 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17603 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17604 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17605 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017606 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17609 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17610 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17611 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17612 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17613 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17614 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17615 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17616 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017618req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17619 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17620 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17621 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17622 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017624req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17625 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17626 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17627 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17628 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17629 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17630 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17631 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17632 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017633 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017635 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017637 ACL derivatives :
17638 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17639 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17640 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17641 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17642 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17643 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17644 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17645 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17646
17647req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17648hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17649 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17650 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17651 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17652 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17653 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17654 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17655 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17656 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17657 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17658
17659req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17660hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17661 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17662 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17663 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17664 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17665 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017666 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017667 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17668 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17669
17670req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17671hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17672 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17673 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17674 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17675 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17676 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17677 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17678 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17679
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017680
17681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17683 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17684 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17685 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17686 basic auth is supported.
17687
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017688http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17689 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17690 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17691 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17692 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017693 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17694 basic auth is supported.
17695
17696 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017697 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17698 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17699 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17700 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017701
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017702http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017703 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17704 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17705 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017706
17707http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017708 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17709 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17710 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017711
17712http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017713 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17714 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17715 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017717http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017718 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17719 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017720 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17721 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017723method : integer + string
17724 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17725 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17726 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17727 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17728 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17729 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17730 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017732 ACL derivatives :
17733 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017735 Example :
17736 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17737 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17738 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017740path : string
17741 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17742 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17743 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17744 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17745 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017746 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017749 ACL derivatives :
17750 path : exact string match
17751 path_beg : prefix match
17752 path_dir : subdir match
17753 path_dom : domain match
17754 path_end : suffix match
17755 path_len : length match
17756 path_reg : regex match
17757 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017758
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017759query : string
17760 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17761 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17762 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17763 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017764 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017765 which stops before the question mark.
17766
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017767req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17768 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17769 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17770 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17771 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017773req.ver : string
17774req_ver : string (deprecated)
17775 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17776 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17777 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017779 ACL derivatives :
17780 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017781
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017782res.body : binary
17783 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17784 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17785 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17786 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17787
17788res.body_len : integer
17789 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17790 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17791 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17792 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17793
17794res.body_size : integer
17795 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17796 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17797 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17798 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17799 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17800 based expect rules.
17801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017802res.comp : boolean
17803 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17804 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17805 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017807res.comp_algo : string
17808 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17809 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17810 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017812res.cook([<name>]) : string
17813scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17814 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17815 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017816 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17817 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819 ACL derivatives :
17820 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017822res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17823scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17824 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17825 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017826 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17827 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17830scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17831 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17832 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017833 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17834 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017836res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17837 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17838 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17839 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17840 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17841 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17842 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17843 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17844 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017845 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17848 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17849 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17850 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17851 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017852 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17853 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017855res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17856shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17857 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17858 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17859 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17860 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17861 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17862 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17863 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017864 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17865 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867 ACL derivatives :
17868 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17869 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17870 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17871 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17872 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17873 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17874 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17875 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17876
17877res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17878shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17879 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17880 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17881 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17882 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017883 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017885res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17886shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17887 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17888 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17889 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17890 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17891 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017892 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17893 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017894
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017895res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17896 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17897 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17898 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017899 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17900 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017902res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17903shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17904 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17905 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17906 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17907 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17908 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017909 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17910 based expect rules.
17911
17912res.hdrs : string
17913 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17914 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17915 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17916 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17917 based expect rules.
17918
17919res.hdrs_bin : binary
17920 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17921 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17922 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17923 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17924 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17925 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17926 (length of 0 for both).
17927
17928 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17929
17930 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17931 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017933res.ver : string
17934resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17935 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017936 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17937 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017939 ACL derivatives :
17940 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017942set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17943 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17944 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017945 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017948 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17949 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017951status : integer
17952 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17953 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017954 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17955 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017956
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017957unique-id : string
17958 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17959 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17960 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17961 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17962 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17963 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017965url : string
17966 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17967 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17968 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17969 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17970 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17971 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17972 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017974 ACL derivatives :
17975 url : exact string match
17976 url_beg : prefix match
17977 url_dir : subdir match
17978 url_dom : domain match
17979 url_end : suffix match
17980 url_len : length match
17981 url_reg : regex match
17982 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017984url_ip : ip
17985 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17986 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17987 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17988 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17989 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17990 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17991 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017993url_port : integer
17994 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17995 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17996 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17997 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017998
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017999urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18000url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18002 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018003 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18004 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18005 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18006 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018007 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18008 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018009 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18010 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018012 ACL derivatives :
18013 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18014 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18015 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18016 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18017 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18018 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18019 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18020 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018021
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018023 Example :
18024 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18025 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18026 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18027 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018028
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018029urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018030 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18031 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18032 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018033
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018034url32 : integer
18035 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18036 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18037 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18038 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18039 is an unsigned integer.
18040
18041url32+src : binary
18042 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18043 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18044 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18045
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018046
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200180477.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018048---------------------------------------
18049
18050This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18051used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18052purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18053There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18054or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18055any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18056for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18057
18058internal.htx.data : integer
18059 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18060 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18061
18062internal.htx.free : integer
18063 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18064 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18065
18066internal.htx.free_data : integer
18067 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18068 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18069
18070internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18071 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18072 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18073 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18074
18075internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18076 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18077 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18078
18079internal.htx.size : integer
18080 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18081 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18082
18083internal.htx.used : integer
18084 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18085 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18086 direction.
18087
18088internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18089 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18090 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18091 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18092 of the special value :
18093 * head : The oldest inserted block
18094 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018095 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018096
18097internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18098 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18099 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18100 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18101 integer or one of the special value :
18102 * head : The oldest inserted block
18103 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018104 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018105
18106internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18107 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18108 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18109 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18110 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18111
18112 * head : The oldest inserted block
18113 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018114 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018115
18116internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18117 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18118 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18119 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18120 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18121
18122 * head : The oldest inserted block
18123 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018124 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018125
18126internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18127 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18128 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18129 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18130 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18131
18132 * head : The oldest inserted block
18133 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018134 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018135
18136internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18137 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18138 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18139 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18140 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18141
18142 * head : The oldest inserted block
18143 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018144 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018145
18146internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18147 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18148 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18149 it returns false.
18150
18151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200181527.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018153---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018155Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18156every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018157order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018159ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18160---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018161FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018162HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018163HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18164HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018165HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18166HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18167HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18168HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18169LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018170METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018171METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018172METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18173METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18174METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18175METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018176METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018177METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018178RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018179REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018180TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018181WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18182---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018183
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181858. Logging
18186----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018188One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18189provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18190very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18191provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18192state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018193to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018194headers.
18195
18196In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18197about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18198send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18199
18200 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18201 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18202 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18203 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18204 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018205 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018206 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018207
18208The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18209allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18210as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18211while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18212real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18213delay.
18214
18215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182168.1. Log levels
18217---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018218
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018219TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018220source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018221HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18222in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18223track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18224syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18225about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018226
18227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182288.2. Log formats
18229----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018230
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018231HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018232and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18233slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18234options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018235
18236 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18237 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18238 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18239 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18240 extents.
18241
18242 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18243 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18244 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18245 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18246 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18247
18248 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18249 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18250 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18251 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18252 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18253
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018254 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18255 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18256 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18257 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18258
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018259 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18260
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018261Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18262specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18263field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18264servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18265always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18266identifier.
18267
18268Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18269 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18270 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18271 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18272 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18273
18274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182758.2.1. Default log format
18276-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018277
18278This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18279as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18280format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18281
18282 Example :
18283 listen www
18284 mode http
18285 log global
18286 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18287
18288 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18289 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18290 (www/HTTP)
18291
18292 Field Format Extract from the example above
18293 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18294 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18295 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18296 4 'to' to
18297 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18298 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18299
18300Detailed fields description :
18301 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18302 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18303 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18304 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18305 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18306 and processed the connection.
18307 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18308
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018309In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18310"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18311connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18312
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018313It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18314will eventually disappear.
18315
18316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183178.2.2. TCP log format
18318---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018319
18320The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18321is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18322information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18323counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18324emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18325environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18326the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18327sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018328specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18329not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18330fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18331marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018332
18333 Example :
18334 frontend fnt
18335 mode tcp
18336 option tcplog
18337 log global
18338 default_backend bck
18339
18340 backend bck
18341 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18342
18343 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18344 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18345 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18346
18347 Field Format Extract from the example above
18348 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18349 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18350 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18351 4 frontend_name fnt
18352 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18353 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18354 7 bytes_read* 212
18355 8 termination_state --
18356 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18357 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18358
18359Detailed fields description :
18360 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018361 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18362 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18363 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018364 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018365 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018366 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018367
18368 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018369 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18370 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18371 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018372
18373 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18374 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18375 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018376 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18377 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18378 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18379 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018380
18381 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18382 and processed the connection.
18383
18384 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18385 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18386 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18387 applications.
18388
18389 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18390 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18391 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18392 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18393 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18394
18395 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18396 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18397 See "Timers" below for more details.
18398
18399 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18400 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18401 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18402 "Timers" below for more details.
18403
18404 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018405 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018406 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18407 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18408 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18409 details.
18410
18411 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18412 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18413 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18414 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18415 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18416
18417 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18418 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18419 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18420 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18421 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18422 for more details.
18423
18424 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018425 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018426 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18427 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18428 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018429 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018430
18431 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18432 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18433 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18434 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18435 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18436 caused by a denial of service attack.
18437
18438 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18439 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18440 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18441 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18442 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18443 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18444 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18445 denial of service attack.
18446
18447 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18448 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18449 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18450 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18451 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18452 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18453 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18454 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18455 be processed than on other servers.
18456
18457 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18458 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18459 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18460 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18461 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18462 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18463 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18464 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18465 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18466 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18467 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18468 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18469 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18470
18471 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18472 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18473 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18474 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18475 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18476 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018477 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018478 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18479
18480 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18481 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18482 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18483 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18484 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18485 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018486 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018487 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18488 occurs.
18489
18490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184918.2.3. HTTP log format
18492----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018493
18494The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18495is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18496the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18497are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18498emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18499generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18500"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18501which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018502frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18503is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018504
18505Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18506slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18507with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18508
18509 Example :
18510 frontend http-in
18511 mode http
18512 option httplog
18513 log global
18514 default_backend bck
18515
18516 backend static
18517 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18518
18519 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18520 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18521 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018522 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018523
18524 Field Format Extract from the example above
18525 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18526 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018527 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018528 4 frontend_name http-in
18529 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018530 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018531 7 status_code 200
18532 8 bytes_read* 2750
18533 9 captured_request_cookie -
18534 10 captured_response_cookie -
18535 11 termination_state ----
18536 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18537 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18538 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18539 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18540 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018542Detailed fields description :
18543 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018544 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18545 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18546 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018547 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018548 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018549 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018550
18551 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018552 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18553 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18554 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018555
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018556 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18557 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018558
18559 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18560 and processed the connection.
18561
18562 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18563 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18564 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18565
18566 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18567 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18568 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18569 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18570 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18571 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18572
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018573 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18574 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18575 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018576 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018577 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18578 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018579 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18580 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018581
18582 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18583 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018584 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018585
18586 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18587 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018588 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18589 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018590
18591 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18592 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18593 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18594 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18595 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018596 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18597 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018598
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018599 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18600 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18601 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18602 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18603 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18604 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18605 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018606 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018607
18608 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18609 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18610 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18611
18612 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18613 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018614 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018615 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18616 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18617 overflowing.
18618
18619 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18620 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18621 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18622 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18623 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18624 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18625 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18626 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18627
18628 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18629 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18630 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18631 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18632 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18633 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18634 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18635 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18636
18637 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18638 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18639 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18640 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18641 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18642 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18643 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18644
18645 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018646 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018647 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18648 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18649 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018650 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018651 system.
18652
18653 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18654 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18655 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18656 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18657 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18658 caused by a denial of service attack.
18659
18660 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18661 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18662 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18663 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18664 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18665 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18666 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18667 denial of service attack.
18668
18669 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18670 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18671 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18672 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18673 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18674 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18675 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18676 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18677 processed than on other servers.
18678
18679 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18680 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18681 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18682 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18683 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18684 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18685 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18686 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18687 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18688 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18689 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18690 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18691 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18692
18693 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18694 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18695 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18696 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18697 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18698 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018699 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018700 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18701
18702 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18703 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18704 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18705 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18706 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18707 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018708 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018709 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18710 occurs.
18711
18712 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18713 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18714 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18715 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18716 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18717 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18718 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18719 cookies" below for more details.
18720
18721 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18722 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18723 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18724 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18725 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18726 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18727 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18728 and cookies" below for more details.
18729
18730 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18731 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18732 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18733 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18734 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18735 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18736 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18737 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18738
18739
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200187408.2.4. Custom log format
18741------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018742
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018743The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018744mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018746HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018747Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18748separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18749prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18750
18751Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18752variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018753("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018754
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018755If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018756as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018757less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18758the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18759
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018760Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018761In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018762in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018763
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018764Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18765'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18766https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18767such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18768
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018769Flags are :
18770 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018771 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018772 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18773 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018774
18775 Example:
18776
18777 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18778 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18779
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018780 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18781
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018782At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18783
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018784 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18785 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018786
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018787the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018788
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018789 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18790 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18791 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018792
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018793and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18794
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018795 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18796 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018797
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018798Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18799
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018800 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018801 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018802 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18803 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18804 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018805 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18806 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18807 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018808 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018809 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18810 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018811 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018812 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18813 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018814 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018815 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018816 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018817 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018818 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018819 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018820 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018821 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18822 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18823 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18824 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18825 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018826 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018827 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018828 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018829 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018830 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018831 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18832 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018833 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18834 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18835 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018836 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018837 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18838 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018839 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018840 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18841 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18842 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018843 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018844 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018845 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18846 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18847 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18848 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018849 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018850 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018851 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018852 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018853 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018854 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018855 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18856 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18857 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018858 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018859 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18860 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018861 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018862 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18863 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018864 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018865 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018866 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018867 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018868
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018869 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018870
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018871
188728.2.5. Error log format
18873-----------------------
18874
18875When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18876protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18877By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18878"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018879will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018880logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18881
18882The format looks like this :
18883
18884 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18885 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18886 Connection error during SSL handshake
18887
18888 Field Format Extract from the example above
18889 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18890 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18891 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18892 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18893 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18894
18895These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18896failures.
18897
18898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188998.3. Advanced logging options
18900-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018901
18902Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18903just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18904options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18905for more information about their usage.
18906
18907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189088.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18909------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018910
18911It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18912haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18913commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18914monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18915ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18916
18917 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18918 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18919 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18920 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18921
18922 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18923 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18924 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018925 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018926 such as other load-balancers.
18927
18928 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18929 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18930 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18931
18932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189338.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18934----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018935
18936The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18937what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18938or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018939"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018940just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18941log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18942after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18943is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18944with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18945with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18946
18947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189488.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18949------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018950
18951Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18952for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18953"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18954retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18955raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18956a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18957file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18958you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18959"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18960
18961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189628.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18963--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018964
18965Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18966multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18967them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18968"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18969logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18970error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18971and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18972too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18973useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18974alternative.
18975
18976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189778.4. Timing events
18978------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018979
18980Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18981reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18982the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18983frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018984mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18985addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18986
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018987Timings events in HTTP mode:
18988
18989 first request 2nd request
18990 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18991 t tr t tr ...
18992 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18993 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18994 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18995 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018996 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018997 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18998
18999Timings events in TCP mode:
19000
19001 TCP session
19002 |<----------------->|
19003 t t
19004 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19005 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19006 |<------ Tt ------->|
19007
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019008 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019009 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019010 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19011 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19012 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019013 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019014 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19015 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19016 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19017 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019018
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019019 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19020 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19021 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019022 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19023 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19024 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19025 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19026 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19027 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019028
19029 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19030 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19031 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19032 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19033 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19034 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19035 request typed by hand during a test.
19036
19037 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19038 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019039 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019040 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19041 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19042 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19043 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019044
19045 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19046 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19047 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19048 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19049 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19050
19051 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19052 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19053 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19054 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19055 connection never established.
19056
19057 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19058 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19059 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19060 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19061 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19062 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19063 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19064 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19065 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19066 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19067 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19068
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019069 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19070 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19071 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19072 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19073 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19074 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19075
19076 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19077
19078 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19079 "Ta" can never be negative.
19080
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019081 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19082 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019083 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19084 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019085 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019086
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019087 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019088
19089 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019090 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19091 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019092
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019093 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19094 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19095 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19096 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19097 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19098 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19099 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19100 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19101
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019102These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19103protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19104that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019105due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19106"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19107that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019108
19109Most common cases :
19110
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019111 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19112 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19113 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19114 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19115 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19116 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19117 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19118 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19119 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19120 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19121 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019122 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019123
19124 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19125 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19126 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19127 of ms on remote networks.
19128
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019129 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19130 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19131 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019132
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019133 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19134 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19135 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19136 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19137 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19138 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19139 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19140 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19141 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019142
19143Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19144
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019145 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019146 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019147 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019148
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019149 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019150 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19151 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19152
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019153 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019154 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19155 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19156 flags.
19157
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019158 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19159 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019160 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19161 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19162 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19163 the client connection was maintained open.
19164
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019165 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019166 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019167 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019168 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19169
19170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191718.5. Session state at disconnection
19172-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019173
19174TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19175"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
191762-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19177each of which has a special meaning :
19178
19179 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19180 session to terminate :
19181
19182 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19183
19184 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19185 server explicitly refused it.
19186
19187 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19188 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19189 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19190 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019191 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019192
19193 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19194 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019195
19196 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19197 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19198 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19199 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19200 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19201
19202 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19203 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19204 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19205 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19206 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19207
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019208 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19209 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19210
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019211 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19212 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19213 backup connections when going up.
19214
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019215 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19216
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019217 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19218 send or receive data.
19219
19220 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19221 send or receive data.
19222
19223 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19224 with nothing left in the buffers.
19225
19226 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19227
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019228 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019229 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19230
19231 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19232 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19233 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19234 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19235 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19236
19237 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19238 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19239
19240 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19241 server (HTTP only).
19242
19243 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19244
19245 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19246 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19247 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19248
19249 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19250 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19251 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19252
19253 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19254
19255 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19256 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19257
19258 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19259 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19260 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19261
19262 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19263 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019264 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19265 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019266
19267 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19268 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19269 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19270 another server.
19271
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019272 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019273 server.
19274
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019275 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19276 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19277 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19278 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19279
19280 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19281 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19282 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19283 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19284
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019285 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19286 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19287 "use-server" rule).
19288
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019289 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19290
19291 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19292 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19293
19294 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19295
19296 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19297 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19298 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19299
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019300 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19301 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019302 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019303 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19304 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19305
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019306 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19307
19308 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19309 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19310
19311 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19312
19313 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19314
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019315The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19316was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019317helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19318starvation, attacks, etc...
19319
19320The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19321alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19322easier finding and understanding.
19323
19324 Flags Reason
19325
19326 -- Normal termination.
19327
19328 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19329 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19330 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19331 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19332
19333 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19334 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19335 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19336 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19337 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19338 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019339
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019340 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19341 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019342 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019343
19344 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19345 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19346 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19347
19348 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19349 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19350 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19351 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19352 the server takes too long to respond.
19353
19354 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19355 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19356 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19357 long a time to respond.
19358
19359 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19360 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19361 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19362 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019363 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19364 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019365
19366 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19367 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19368 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19369 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19370 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019371 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019372 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19373 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19374 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19375 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19376 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19377 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19378 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19379 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019380 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019381 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19382 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19383 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019384
19385 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19386 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019387 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19388 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19389 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19390 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019391
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019392 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19393 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019395 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019396 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19397 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019398 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019399 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19400 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19401
19402 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19403 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19404 503 or 504 here.
19405
19406 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19407 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19408 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19409 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19410 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19411
19412 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19413 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019414 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019415 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19416 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19417
19418 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19419 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19420 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19421 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19422 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19423 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19424 between haproxy and the server.
19425
19426 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19427 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19428 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19429 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19430 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19431 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19432 solution is to fix the application.
19433
19434 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19435 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19436 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19437 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19438 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19439 external attacks.
19440
19441 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19442 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019443 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019444 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19445 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19446
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019447 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19448 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19449 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019450 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019451 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019452
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019453 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19454 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19455 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19456 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019457 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19458 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19459 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19460 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19461 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019462
19463 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19464 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19465 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19466 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19467
19468 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19469 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19470 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19471 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19472
19473 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19474 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19475 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19476 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19477
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019478The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19479persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19480important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19481re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19482
19483 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19484
19485 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19486 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19487 set on a GET request.
19488
19489 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19490 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019491 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019492 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19493
19494 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19495 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19496 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19497
19498 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19499 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19500 already got a cookie.
19501
19502 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19503 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19504 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19505 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19506 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19507
19508 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19509 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19510 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19511
19512 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19513 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19514 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19515
19516 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19517 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19518
19519 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19520 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19521 then advertised in the response.
19522
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195248.6. Non-printable characters
19525-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019526
19527In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19528consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19529converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19530prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19531being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19532escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19533is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19534'}' when logging headers.
19535
19536Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19537issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19538containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19539
19540Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19541the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19542performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19543
19544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195458.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19546---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019547
19548Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19549achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019550section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019551cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19552the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19553the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019554locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019555not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19556user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19557a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19558wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19559
19560 Examples :
19561 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19562 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19563
19564 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19565 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19566
19567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195688.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19569---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019570
19571Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19572proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19573the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19574server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19575
19576Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19577response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019578section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019579
19580It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019581time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19582appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019583are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19584and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19585follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19586request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19587in the logs.
19588
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019589As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19590frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19591an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19592
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019593 Example :
19594 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19595 listen proxy-out
19596 mode http
19597 option httplog
19598 option logasap
19599 log global
19600 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19601
19602 # log the name of the virtual server
19603 capture request header Host len 20
19604
19605 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19606 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19607
19608 # log the beginning of the referrer
19609 capture request header Referer len 20
19610
19611 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19612 capture response header Server len 20
19613
19614 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19615 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19616
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019617 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019618 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19619
19620 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19621 capture response header Via len 20
19622
19623 # log the URL location during a redirection
19624 capture response header Location len 20
19625
19626 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19627 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19628 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19629 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19630 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19631
19632 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19633 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19634 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19635 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019636 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019637
19638 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19639 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19640 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19641 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19642 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019643 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019644
19645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196468.9. Examples of logs
19647---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019648
19649These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19650them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19651reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19652
19653 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19654 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19655 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19656
19657 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19658 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19659
19660 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19661 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19662 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19663
19664 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19665 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19666
19667 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19668 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19669 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19670
19671 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019672 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019673 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19674 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19675
19676 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19677 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19678 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19679
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019680 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19681 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19682 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19683 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19684 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19685 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019686
19687 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019688 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019689
19690 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19691 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19692 Nothing was sent to any server.
19693
19694 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19695 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19696
19697 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19698 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019699 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019700 send a 408 return code to the client.
19701
19702 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19703 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19704
19705 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19706 5 seconds ("c----").
19707
19708 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19709 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019710 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019711
19712 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019713 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019714 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19715 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19716 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19717 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19718 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019719
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019720
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200197219. Supported filters
19722--------------------
19723
19724Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19725accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19726unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19727
19728See also : "filter"
19729
197309.1. Trace
19731----------
19732
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019733filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019734
19735 Arguments:
19736 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19737 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19738
19739 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19740 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19741 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19742 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19743
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019744 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019745 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19746 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19747 amount of the parsed data.
19748
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019749 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019750
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019751This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19752callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19753information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19754filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19755
19756Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19757tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19758a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19759
19760
197619.2. HTTP compression
19762---------------------
19763
19764filter compression
19765
19766The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19767keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019768when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19769fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19770done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19771explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19772filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19773listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19774order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019775
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019776See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19777 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019778
19779
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200197809.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19781--------------------------------------------
19782
19783filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19784
19785 Arguments :
19786
19787 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19788 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19789 parsed.
19790
19791 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19792 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19793 part must be placed in its own scope.
19794
19795The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19796external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019797streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019798exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19799also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19800
19801SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19802the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19803
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019804For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019805"doc/SPOE.txt".
19806
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100198079.4. Cache
19808----------
19809
19810filter cache <name>
19811
19812 Arguments :
19813
19814 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19815
19816The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19817"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019818cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019819other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19820case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19821is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19822filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019823listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19824order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019825
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019826See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19827 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19828
19829
198309.5. Fcgi-app
19831-------------
19832
19833filter fcg-app <name>
19834
19835 Arguments :
19836
19837 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19838
19839The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19840request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19841reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19842used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19843implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19844used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19845fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19846used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19847order.
19848
19849See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19850 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19851
19852
1985310. FastCGI applications
19854-------------------------
19855
19856HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19857feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19858the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19859FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19860servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19861FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19862backend.
19863
19864HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19865application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19866connection.
19867
1986810.1. Setup
19869-----------
19870
1987110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19872--------------------------
19873
19874fcgi-app <name>
19875 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19876 document root must be defined.
19877
19878acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19879 Declare or complete an access list.
19880
19881 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19882 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19883 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19884 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19885 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19886
19887docroot <path>
19888 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19889 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19890 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19891
19892index <script-name>
19893 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19894 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19895 is an optional setting.
19896
19897 Example :
19898 index index.php
19899
19900log-stderr global
19901log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19902 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19903 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19904
19905 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19906 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19907
19908pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19909 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19910 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19911 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19912
19913 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19914 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19915 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19916 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19917
19918 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19919 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19920
19921path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019922 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019923 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19924 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19925 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19926 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19927 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19928 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19929 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019930
19931 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019932 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019933 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19934 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19935 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19936 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019937
19938 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019939 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19940 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019941
19942option get-values
19943no option get-values
19944 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19945
19946 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19947 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19948
19949 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19950 application will accept.
19951
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019952 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19953 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019954
19955 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050019956 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019957 option is disabled.
19958
19959 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19960 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19961 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19962 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19963 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19964 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19965
19966option keep-conn
19967no option keep-conn
19968 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19969 sending a response.
19970
19971 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19972 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19973
19974option max-reqs <reqs>
19975 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19976 accept.
19977
19978 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19979 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19980 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19981 to 1.
19982
19983option mpxs-conns
19984no option mpxs-conns
19985 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19986
19987 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19988 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19989
19990set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19991 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19992 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19993 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19994 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19995
19996 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19997 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19998 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19999
20000 Example :
20001 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20002 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20003
20004 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20005
20006
2000710.1.2. Proxy section
20008---------------------
20009
20010use-fcgi-app <name>
20011 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20012
20013 Arguments :
20014 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20015
20016 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20017 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20018 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20019 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20020 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20021
20022 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20023 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20024 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20025 application are evaluated.
20026
20027
2002810.1.3. Example
20029---------------
20030
20031 frontend front-http
20032 mode http
20033 bind *:80
20034 bind *:
20035
20036 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20037 default_backend back-static
20038
20039 backend back-static
20040 mode http
20041 server www A.B.C.D:80
20042
20043 backend back-dynamic
20044 mode http
20045 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20046 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20047
20048 fcgi-app php-fpm
20049 log-stderr global
20050 option keep-conn
20051
20052 docroot /var/www/my-app
20053 index index.php
20054 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20055
20056
2005710.2. Default parameters
20058------------------------
20059
20060A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20061the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020062script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020063applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20064
20065 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20066 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20067 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20068 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20069 | | |
20070 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20071 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20072 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20073 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20074 | | application. |
20075 | | |
20076 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20077 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20078 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20079 | | |
20080 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20081 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20082 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20083 | | the application's configuration. |
20084 | | |
20085 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20086 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20087 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20088 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20089 | | |
20090 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20091 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20092 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20093 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20094 | | be defined. |
20095 | | |
20096 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20097 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20098 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20099 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20100 | | is not set too. |
20101 | | |
20102 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20103 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20104 | | set. |
20105 | | |
20106 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20107 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20108 | | the request. |
20109 | | |
20110 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20111 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20112 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20113 | | |
20114 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20115 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20116 | | script to process the request. |
20117 | | |
20118 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20119 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20120 | | |
20121 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20122 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20123 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20124 | | |
20125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20126 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20127 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20128 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20129 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20130 | | |
20131 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20132 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20133 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20134 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20135 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20136 | | side. |
20137 | | |
20138 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20139 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20140 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20141 | | connected to. |
20142 | | |
20143 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20144 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20145 | | |
20146 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20147 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20148 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20149 | | |
20150 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20151
20152
2015310.3. Limitations
20154------------------
20155
20156The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20157way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20158during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20159establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20160application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20161or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20162message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20163these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20164and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20165
20166Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20167request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20168requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20169
20170About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20171into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20172fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20173"http-request" ones.
20174
20175Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20176FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20177processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20178must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20179here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020181/*
20182 * Local variables:
20183 * fill-column: 79
20184 * End:
20185 */